blob: a4276f569f6d770a66fd1480acc2f3df4b0b7798 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua02e8a62015-09-14 12:23:10 +02007 2015/09/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200545 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200546 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200549 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200551 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100552 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100553 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200555 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200556 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200557 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - noepoll
559 - nokqueue
560 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100561 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300562 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200563 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200564 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200565 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200566 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200567 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100568 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100569 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200570 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100571 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100572 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100573 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100574 - tune.lua.session-timeout
575 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100576 - tune.maxaccept
577 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200578 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200579 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200580 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100581 - tune.rcvbuf.client
582 - tune.rcvbuf.server
583 - tune.sndbuf.client
584 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100585 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100586 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200587 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100588 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200589 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200590 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200591 - tune.vars.global-max-size
592 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
593 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
594 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100595 - tune.zlib.memlevel
596 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 * Debugging
599 - debug
600 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006033.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604------------------------------------
605
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200606ca-base <dir>
607 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200608 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
609 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611chroot <jail dir>
612 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
613 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
614 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
615 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
616 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
617 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100618
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100619cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
620 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
621 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
622 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100623 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
624 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
625 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
626 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
627 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
628 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
629 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
630 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
631 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
632 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100633
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200634crt-base <dir>
635 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
636 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
637 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
638
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639daemon
640 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
641 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
642 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
643
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200644deviceatlas-json-file <path>
645 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
646 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
647
648deviceatlas-log-level <value>
649 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
650 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
651
652deviceatlas-separator <char>
653 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
654 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
655
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900656external-check
657 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
658 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
659 See "option external-check".
660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661gid <number>
662 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
663 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
664 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100665 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
666 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100668
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200669group <group name>
670 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
671 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100672
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200673log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
675 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100676 configured with "log global".
677
678 <address> can be one of:
679
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100680 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100681 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
682 port).
683
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100684 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
685 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
686 port).
687
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100688 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
689 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
690 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
691 writeable).
692
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200693 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
694 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100695
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200696 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
697 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
698 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
699 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
700 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
701 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
702 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
703 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
704 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
705 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
706 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
707
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100708 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709
710 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
711 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
712 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
713
714 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200715 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
716 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
717 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
718 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
719 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
720 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200722 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100724log-send-hostname [<string>]
725 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
726 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
727 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
728 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
729 the logs.
730
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000731log-tag <string>
732 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
733 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
734 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100735 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000736
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100737lua-load <file>
738 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
739 used multiple times.
740
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200741nbproc <number>
742 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
743 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
744 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
745 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
746 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
747
748pidfile <pidfile>
749 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
750 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
751 starting the process. See also "daemon".
752
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100753stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200754 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
755 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
756 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
757 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
758 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
759 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100760 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200761 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
762 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200763
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200764server-state-base <directory>
765 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200766 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
767 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200768
769server-state-file <file>
770 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
771 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
772 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
773 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
774 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
775 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
776 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
777 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200778 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
779 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200780
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100781ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
783 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300784 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100785 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
786 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
787 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
788 "bind" keyword for more information.
789
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100790ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
792 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
793 keyword to see available options.
794
795 Example:
796 global
797 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
798
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100799ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
801 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300802 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100803 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
804 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
805 information.
806
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100807ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
809 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
810 keyword to see available options.
811
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200812ssl-dh-param-file <file>
813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
814 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
815 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
816 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
817 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
818 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
819 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
820 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
821 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
822 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
823 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
824 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
825
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100826ssl-server-verify [none|required]
827 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
828 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
829 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
830
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200831stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
832 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
833 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
834 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
835 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200836
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200837 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
838 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
839 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200840
841stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
842 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
843 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100844 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200845
846stats maxconn <connections>
847 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
848 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850uid <number>
851 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
852 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
853 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
854 one. See also "gid" and "user".
855
856ulimit-n <number>
857 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
858 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
859 option.
860
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100861unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
862 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
863
864 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
865 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
866 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
867 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
868 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
869 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
870 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
871 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
872 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
873 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
874
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200875user <user name>
876 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
877 See also "uid" and "group".
878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200879node <name>
880 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
881
882 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
883 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
884 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
885 traffic.
886
887description <text>
888 Add a text that describes the instance.
889
890 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
891 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
892 "<" and ">" characters.
893
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010089451degrees-data-file <file path>
895 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
896 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
897
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200898 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100899 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
900
90151degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
902 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
903 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
904 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
905
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200906 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100907 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
908
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020090951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100910 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
911 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
912
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200913 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
914 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
915
91651degrees-cache-size <number>
917 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
918 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
919 By default, this cache is disabled.
920
921 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100922 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
923
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926-----------------------
927
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200928max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
929 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
930 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
931 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
932 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
933 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
934 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
935 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
936 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
937
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200938maxconn <number>
939 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
940 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
941 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200942 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
943 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
944 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
945 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100946 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
947 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
948 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
949 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
950 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200952maxconnrate <number>
953 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
954 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
955 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
956 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
957 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
958 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
959 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
960 fairness.
961
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100962maxcomprate <number>
963 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300964 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100965 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
966 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
967 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
968 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
969 default value.
970
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100971maxcompcpuusage <number>
972 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
973 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
974 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
975 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
976 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
977 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
978 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
979 process down and from introducing high latencies.
980
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100981maxpipes <number>
982 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
983 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
984 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
985 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
986 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
987 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
988
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200989maxsessrate <number>
990 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
991 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
992 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
993 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
994 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
995 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
996 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
997 fairness.
998
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200999maxsslconn <number>
1000 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1001 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1002 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1003 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1004 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1005 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1006 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001007 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1008 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1009 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1010 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1011 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1012 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1013 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001014
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001015maxsslrate <number>
1016 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1017 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1018 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1019 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1020 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1021 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1022 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1023 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1024 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1025 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1026
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001027maxzlibmem <number>
1028 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1029 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1030 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001031 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1032 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1033 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035noepoll
1036 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1037 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001038 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039
1040nokqueue
1041 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1042 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1043 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1044
1045nopoll
1046 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1047 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001048 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001049 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001050
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001051nosplice
1052 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1053 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1054 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001055 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1057 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1058 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1059 "option splice-response".
1060
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001061nogetaddrinfo
1062 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1063 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1064
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001065spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001066 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1067 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1068 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1069 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1070 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1071 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001072
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001073tune.buffers.limit <number>
1074 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1075 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1076 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1077 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1078 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1079 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1080 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1081 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1082 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1083 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1084 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1085 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1086 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1087 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1088 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1089
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001090tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1091 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1092 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1093 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1094 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1095
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001096tune.bufsize <number>
1097 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1098 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1099 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1100 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1101 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1102 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1103 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1104 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001105 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1106 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1107 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001108
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001109tune.chksize <number>
1110 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1111 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1112 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1113 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1114 checks whenever possible.
1115
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001116tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1117 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1118 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1119 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1120 this value. The default value is 1.
1121
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001122tune.http.cookielen <number>
1123 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1124 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1125 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1126 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1127 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1128 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1129 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1130 to change this value.
1131
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001132tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1133 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1134 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1135 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1136 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1137 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1138 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1139 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1140 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1141 limit too high.
1142
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001143tune.idletimer <timeout>
1144 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1145 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1146 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1147 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1148 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1149 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1150 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1151 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1152 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1153
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001154tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1155 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1156 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1157 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1158 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1159 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1160 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1161 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1162
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001163tune.lua.maxmem
1164 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1165 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1166 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1167 memory.
1168
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001169tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1170 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1171 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1172 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1173 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1174 4s.
1175
1176tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1177 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1178 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1179 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1180 check servers.
1181
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001182tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001183 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1184 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1185 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1186 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1187 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1188 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1189 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1190 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1191 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1192 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001193
1194tune.maxpollevents <number>
1195 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1196 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1197 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1198 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1199 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1200
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001201tune.maxrewrite <number>
1202 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1203 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1204 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1205 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1206 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1207 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1208 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1209 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1210 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1211 bufsize.
1212
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001213tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1214 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1215 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1216 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1217 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1218 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1219 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1220 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1221 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1222 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1223 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1224 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1225 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1226 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1227 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1228 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1229 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1230 setting this parameter to 0.
1231
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001232tune.pipesize <number>
1233 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1234 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1235 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1236 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1237 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1238 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1239
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001240tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1241tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1242 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1243 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1244 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1245 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1246 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1247 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1248 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1249
1250tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1251tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1252 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1253 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1254 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1255 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1256 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1257 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1258 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1259 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1260 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1261 notifying haproxy again.
1262
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001263tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001264 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1265 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1266 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001267 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001268 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1269 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1270 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1271 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1272 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001273 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1274 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001275
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001276tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1277 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1278 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1279 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1280 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1281 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1282 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1283
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001284tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1285 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001286 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001287 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1288 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1289 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1290 being used for too long.
1291
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001292tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1293 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1294 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1295 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1296 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1297 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1298 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1299 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1300 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1301 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1302 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001303 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1304 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001305
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001306tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1307 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1308 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1309 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1310 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1311 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1312 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1313 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001314 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1315 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001316
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001317tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1318 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1319 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1320 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1321 1000 entries.
1322
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001323tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1324tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1325tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1326tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1327 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1328 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1329 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1330 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1331 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1332
1333 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1334 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1335 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1336 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1337
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001338tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1339 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001340 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001341 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1342 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1343 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1344
1345tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1346 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1347 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1348 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1349 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013513.3. Debugging
1352--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001353
1354debug
1355 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1356 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1357 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1358 system startup.
1359
1360quiet
1361 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1362 line argument "-q".
1363
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013653.4. Userlists
1366--------------
1367It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1368http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1369it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1370
1371userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001372 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001373 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1374
1375group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001376 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001377 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1378 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1379
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001380user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1381 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001382 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1383 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001384 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1385 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001386 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001387 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001388
1389
1390 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001391 userlist L1
1392 group G1 users tiger,scott
1393 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001394
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001395 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1396 user scott insecure-password elgato
1397 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001398
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001399 userlist L2
1400 group G1
1401 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001402
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001403 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1404 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1405 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001406
1407 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001408
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001409
14103.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001411----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001412It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1413several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1414instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1415values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1416automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1417In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1418using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1419tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1420reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1421Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1422that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1423each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001424
1425peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001426 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001427 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1428
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001429disabled
1430 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1431 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1432 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1433
1434enable
1435 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1436
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001437peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1438 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1439 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1440 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1441 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1442 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1443 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1444
1445 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1446 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1447
1448 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1449 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1450 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1451 across all peers.
1452
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001453 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1454 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001455
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001456 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001457 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001458 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1459 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1460 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001461
1462 backend mybackend
1463 mode tcp
1464 balance roundrobin
1465 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1466 stick on src
1467
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001468 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1469 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001470
1471
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014723.6. Mailers
1473------------
1474It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1475If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1476in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1477
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001478mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001479 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1480 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1481
1482mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1483 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1484
1485 Example:
1486 mailers mymailers
1487 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1488 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1489
1490 backend mybackend
1491 mode tcp
1492 balance roundrobin
1493
1494 email-alert mailers mymailers
1495 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1496 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1497
1498 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1499 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1500
1501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015024. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001503----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001505Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001506 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001507 - frontend <name>
1508 - backend <name>
1509 - listen <name>
1510
1511A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1512its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1513section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001514section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001515
1516A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1517connections.
1518
1519A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1520to forward incoming connections.
1521
1522A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1523parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001525All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1526'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1527case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1528
1529Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1530logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1531proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1532However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1533name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1534
1535Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1536and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001537bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001538protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1539modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1540arbitrary criteria.
1541
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001542In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1543a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1544the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1545
1546 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1547 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1548 between responses and new requests.
1549
1550 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1551 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1552 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1553 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1554
1555 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1556 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1557 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1558
1559 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1560 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1561 client-facing connection remains open.
1562
1563 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1564 after the end of the response.
1565
1566The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1567frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1568following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1569weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1570
1571 Backend mode
1572
1573 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1574 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1575 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1576 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1577 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1578 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1579 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1580 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1581 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1582 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1583 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001585
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015874.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1588--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001590The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1591limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1592they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1593limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001594marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001595option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001596and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1597with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1598specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001600
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001601 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1602------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1603acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001604appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001605backlog X X X -
1606balance X - X X
1607bind - X X -
1608bind-process X X X X
1609block - X X X
1610capture cookie - X X -
1611capture request header - X X -
1612capture response header - X X -
1613clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001614compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001615contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1616cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001617declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001618default-server X - X X
1619default_backend X X X -
1620description - X X X
1621disabled X X X X
1622dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001623email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001624email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001625email-alert mailers X X X X
1626email-alert myhostname X X X X
1627email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001628enabled X X X X
1629errorfile X X X X
1630errorloc X X X X
1631errorloc302 X X X X
1632-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1633errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001634force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001635fullconn X - X X
1636grace X X X X
1637hash-type X - X X
1638http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001639http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001640http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001641http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001642http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001643http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001644http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001645id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001646ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001647load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001648log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001649log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001650log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001651max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001652maxconn X X X -
1653mode X X X X
1654monitor fail - X X -
1655monitor-net X X X -
1656monitor-uri X X X -
1657option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1658option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1659option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1660option allbackups (*) X - X X
1661option checkcache (*) X - X X
1662option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1663option contstats (*) X X X -
1664option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1665option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1666option forceclose (*) X X X X
1667-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1668option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001669option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001670option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001671option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001672option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001673option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001674option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001675option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001676option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1677option httpchk X - X X
1678option httpclose (*) X X X X
1679option httplog X X X X
1680option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001681option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001682option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001683option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001684option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1685option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1686option logasap (*) X X X -
1687option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001688option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001689option nolinger (*) X X X X
1690option originalto X X X X
1691option persist (*) X - X X
1692option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001693option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001694option smtpchk X - X X
1695option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1696option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1697option splice-request (*) X X X X
1698option splice-response (*) X X X X
1699option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1700option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001702option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001703option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1704option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1705option tcpka X X X X
1706option tcplog X X X X
1707option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001708external-check command X - X X
1709external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001710persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1711rate-limit sessions X X X -
1712redirect - X X X
1713redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1714redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1715reqadd - X X X
1716reqallow - X X X
1717reqdel - X X X
1718reqdeny - X X X
1719reqiallow - X X X
1720reqidel - X X X
1721reqideny - X X X
1722reqipass - X X X
1723reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724reqitarpit - X X X
1725reqpass - X X X
1726reqrep - X X X
1727-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001728reqtarpit - X X X
1729retries X - X X
1730rspadd - X X X
1731rspdel - X X X
1732rspdeny - X X X
1733rspidel - X X X
1734rspideny - X X X
1735rspirep - X X X
1736rsprep - X X X
1737server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001738server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001739source X - X X
1740srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001741stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001742stats auth X - X X
1743stats enable X - X X
1744stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001745stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001746stats realm X - X X
1747stats refresh X - X X
1748stats scope X - X X
1749stats show-desc X - X X
1750stats show-legends X - X X
1751stats show-node X - X X
1752stats uri X - X X
1753-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1754stick match - - X X
1755stick on - - X X
1756stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001757stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001758stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001759tcp-check connect - - X X
1760tcp-check expect - - X X
1761tcp-check send - - X X
1762tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001763tcp-request connection - X X -
1764tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001765tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001766tcp-response content - - X X
1767tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001768timeout check X - X X
1769timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001770timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001771timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1772timeout connect X - X X
1773timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1774timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1775timeout http-request X X X X
1776timeout queue X - X X
1777timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001778timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001779timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1780timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001781timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001783unique-id-format X X X -
1784unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001785use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001786use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001787------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1788 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1792---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793
1794This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1795
1796
1797acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1798 Declare or complete an access list.
1799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1800 no | yes | yes | yes
1801 Example:
1802 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1803 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1804 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001806 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
1808
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001809appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1810 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1813 no | no | yes | yes
1814 Arguments :
1815 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1816 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1817
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001818 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 checked in each cookie value.
1820
1821 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1822 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1823 milliseconds.
1824
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001825 request-learn
1826 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1827 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1828 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1829 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1830 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1831 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1832
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001833 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1834 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1835 data following this prefix.
1836
1837 Example :
1838 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1839
1840 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1841 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1842
1843 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1844 2 modes are currently supported :
1845 - path-parameters :
1846 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1847 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1848 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1849 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1850 - query-string :
1851 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1852 query string.
1853
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001854 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1855 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1856 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001858 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1859 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001860
1861
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001862backlog <conns>
1863 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1865 yes | yes | yes | no
1866 Arguments :
1867 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1868 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001869 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001870
1871 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1872 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1873 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1874 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1875 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1876 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1877 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1878 backlog parameter.
1879
1880 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1881 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1882 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1883
1884 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1885
1886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001888balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1891 yes | no | yes | yes
1892 Arguments :
1893 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1894 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1895 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1896 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1897
1898 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1899 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1900 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1901 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001902 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001903 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001904 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1905 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1906 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1907 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1908 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1909 it, so that you don't worry.
1910
1911 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1912 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1913 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1914 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1915 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1916 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1917 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1918 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001919
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001920 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1921 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1922 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1923 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1924 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1925 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1926 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1927 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1928
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001929 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001930 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001931 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1932 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001933 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001934 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1935 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1936 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1937 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1938 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001939 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1940 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1941 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1942 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1943 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1944 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1947 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1948 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1949 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1950 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1951 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1952 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1953 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001954 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001956 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1957 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1958 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001960 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1961 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1962 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1963 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1964 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1965 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1966 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1967 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1968 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1969 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1970 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1971 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001972
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001973 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001974 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1975 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1976 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1977 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1978 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1979 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1980 URIs start with a leading "/".
1981
1982 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1983 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1984 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1985 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001988 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1989
1990 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001991 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1992 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001993 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1994 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1995 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1996 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001997 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001998 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1999 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002000
2001 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2002 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2003 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2004 server will receive the request.
2005
2006 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2007 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2008 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2009 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2010 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002011 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2012 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2013 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002015 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2016 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2017 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2018 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2019 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002021 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002022 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2023 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2024 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2025
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002026 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2027 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2028 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2029
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002030 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002031 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002032 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2033 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2034 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2035 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2036 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2037 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002038 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002039 used instead.
2040
2041 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2042 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2043 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2044 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2045
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002046 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2047 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2048 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2049
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002050 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002053 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2054 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002055
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002056 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2057 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2058 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059
2060 Examples :
2061 balance roundrobin
2062 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002063 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002064 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2065 balance hdr(host)
2066 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002067
2068 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2069 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002071 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002072 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2073 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2074 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2075 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2076
2077 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2078 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2079 defaults to 16 kB.
2080
2081 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2082 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2083
2084 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2085 Round Robin.
2086
2087 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2088 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2089 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2090 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2091
2092 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2093
2094 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002095 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002096 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2097 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2098 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002100 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101
2102
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002103bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2104bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2107 no | yes | yes | no
2108 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002109 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2110 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2111 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2112 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002113 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002114 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2115 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2116 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2117 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2118 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2119 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2120 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002121 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2122 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2123 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2124 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2125 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2126 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2127 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002128 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2129 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2130 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002131 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2132 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2133 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002134
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002135 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2136 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002137 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2138 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2139 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002140 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2141 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2142 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2143 the range.
2144
2145 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2146 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2147 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2148 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2149 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2150 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2151 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002152 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002153 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002155 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2156 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2157 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2158 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2159 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2160 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2161 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2162 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2163
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002164 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2165 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2166 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2167 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2170 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2171 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2172 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2173 in a frontend.
2174
2175 Example :
2176 listen http_proxy
2177 bind :80,:443
2178 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002179 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002181 listen http_https_proxy
2182 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002183 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002184
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002185 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2186 bind ipv6@:80
2187 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2188 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2189
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002190 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002191 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002192
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002193 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2194 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2195 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2196 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2197 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2198
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002199 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002200 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002201
2202
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002203bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002204 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 yes | yes | yes | yes
2207 Arguments :
2208 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2209 may be used to override a default value.
2210
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002211 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002212 option may be combined with other numbers.
2213
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002214 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002215 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2216 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2217 missing from all processes.
2218
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002219 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002220 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002221 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2222 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2223 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2224 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002225
2226 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2227 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2228 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2229 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2230 and 'even' instances.
2231
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002232 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2233 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2234 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2235 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002236
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002237 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2238 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2239
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002240 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2241 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2242 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2243
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002244 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2245 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2246
2247 Example :
2248 listen app_ip1
2249 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002250 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002251
2252 listen app_ip2
2253 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002254 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002255
2256 listen management
2257 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002258 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002259
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002260 listen management
2261 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2262 bind-process 1-4
2263
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002264 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002265
2266
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002267block { if | unless } <condition>
2268 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2270 no | yes | yes | yes
2271
2272 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2273 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002274 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002275 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2277 "block" statements per instance.
2278
2279 Example:
2280 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2281 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2282 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2283 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002285 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286
2287
2288capture cookie <name> len <length>
2289 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2291 no | yes | yes | no
2292 Arguments :
2293 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2294 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2295 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2296 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2297 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2298
2299 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2300 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2301 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2302 right if it exceeds <length>.
2303
2304 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2305 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2306 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2307 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2308
2309 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2310 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2311 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2312
2313 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2314 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2315 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002316 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2317 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2318 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319
2320 Example:
2321 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2322
2323 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002324 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325
2326
2327capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002328 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2330 no | yes | yes | no
2331 Arguments :
2332 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002333 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2335 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2336 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2337
2338 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2339 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2340 it exceeds <length>.
2341
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002342 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2344 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002345 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2346 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2347 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2348 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002349 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002350 environments to find where the request came from.
2351
2352 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2353 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2354 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2355 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002357 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2358 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2359 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2360 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2361 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002362
2363 Example:
2364 capture request header Host len 15
2365 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2366 capture request header Referrer len 15
2367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002368 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 about logging.
2370
2371
2372capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002373 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2375 no | yes | yes | no
2376 Arguments :
2377 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002378 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2380 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2381 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2382
2383 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2384 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2385 it exceeds <length>.
2386
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002387 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2389 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2390 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002391 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2392 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2393 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2394 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002396 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2397 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2398 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2399 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2400 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402 Example:
2403 capture response header Content-length len 9
2404 capture response header Location len 15
2405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002406 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407 about logging.
2408
2409
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002410clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2413 yes | yes | yes | no
2414 Arguments :
2415 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2416 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2417 as explained at the top of this document.
2418
2419 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2420 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2421 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2422 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2423 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2424 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2425 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2426 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002427 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2429 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2430
2431 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2432 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2433 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2434 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2435 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2436 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2437
2438 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2439 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2440
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002441 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2442 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002444compression algo <algorithm> ...
2445compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002446compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002447 Enable HTTP compression.
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 yes | yes | yes | yes
2450 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002451 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2452 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2453 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2454
2455 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002456 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2457 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2458 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002459
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002460 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2461 support for zlib was built in.
2462
2463 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2464 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2465 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2466 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2467 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2468 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002469
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002470 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2471 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2472 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2473 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2474 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2475 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2476 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2477 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002478
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002479 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002480 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002481 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2482 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2483 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2484 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2485 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002486
2487 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2488 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2489 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2490 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2491 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002492 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2493 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2494 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2495 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2496 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002497 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2498 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002499
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002500 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002501 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2502 "Accept-Encoding" header
2503 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002504 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002505 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2506 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002507 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2508 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2509 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2510 "multipart"
2511 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2512 header
2513 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2514 and later
2515 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2516 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002517
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002518 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2519 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002520
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002521 Examples :
2522 compression algo gzip
2523 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002525contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2528 yes | no | yes | yes
2529 Arguments :
2530 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2532 as explained at the top of this document.
2533
2534 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002535 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002536 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2538 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2539 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2540 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2541
2542 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2543 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2544 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2545 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2546 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2547 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2548
2549 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2550 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2551 instead.
2552
2553 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2554 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2555
2556
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002557cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002558 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2559 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002560 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2562 yes | no | yes | yes
2563 Arguments :
2564 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2565 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2566 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2567 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2568 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2569 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2570 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2571 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2572 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2573
2574 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2575 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2576 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2577 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2578 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2579 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2580 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2581 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2582 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2583 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2584 "insert" and "prefix".
2585
2586 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002587 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002588
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002589 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002590 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2591 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2592 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2593 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2594 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2595 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2596 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2597 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2598 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2599 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002600
2601 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2602 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2603 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2604 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2605 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2606 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2607 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2608 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2609 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2610 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002611 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2612 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2613 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002615 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2616 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2617 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002618 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2619 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2620 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2621 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002622 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2623 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2624 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002625
2626 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2627 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2628 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2629 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2630 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2631 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2632 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2633 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2634 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2635
2636 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2637 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2638 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2639 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2640 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2641 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2642 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2643 persistence cookie in the cache.
2644 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2645
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002646 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2647 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2648 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2649 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2650 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2651 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2652 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2653 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2654 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2655 they logout.
2656
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002657 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2658 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2659 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2660 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2661
2662 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2663 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2664 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2665 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2666 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2667 this attribute.
2668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002669 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002670 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002671 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2672 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2673 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2674 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2675 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2676 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002677
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002678 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2679 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2680 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2681 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2682 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2683 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2684 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2685 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2686 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2687 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2688 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2689 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2690 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2691 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2692 the site.
2693
2694 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2695 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2696 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2697 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2698 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2699 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2700 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2701 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2702 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2703 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2704 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2705 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2706 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2707 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2708 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2709 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2712 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2713 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2714 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716 Examples :
2717 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2718 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2719 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002720 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002722 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002723
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002724
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002725declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2726 Declares a capture slot.
2727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2728 no | yes | yes | no
2729 Arguments:
2730 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2731
2732 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2733 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2734 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2735 for use in the response.
2736
2737 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2738 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2739
2740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002741default-server [param*]
2742 Change default options for a server in a backend
2743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2744 yes | no | yes | yes
2745 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002746 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2747 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2748 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2749 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002750
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002751 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002752 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2753
2754 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757default_backend <backend>
2758 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2760 yes | yes | yes | no
2761 Arguments :
2762 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2763
2764 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2765 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2766 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2767 will catch all undetermined requests.
2768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769 Example :
2770
2771 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2772 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2773 default_backend dynamic
2774
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002775 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002778description <string>
2779 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2781 no | yes | yes | yes
2782 Arguments : string
2783
2784 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2785 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2786 it describes.
2787 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2788
2789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790disabled
2791 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2793 yes | yes | yes | yes
2794 Arguments : none
2795
2796 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2797 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2798 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2799 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2800 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2801 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2802 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2803
2804 See also : "enabled"
2805
2806
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002807dispatch <address>:<port>
2808 Set a default server address
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002811 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002812
2813 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2814 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2815 during start-up.
2816
2817 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2818 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2819 possible with normal servers.
2820
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002821 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002822 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2823 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2824 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2825 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2826
2827 See also : "server"
2828
2829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830enabled
2831 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | yes | yes | yes
2834 Arguments : none
2835
2836 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2837 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2838
2839 See also : "disabled"
2840
2841
2842errorfile <code> <file>
2843 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | yes | yes | yes
2846 Arguments :
2847 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002848 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2849 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002850
2851 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002852 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002853 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002854 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2855 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
2857 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2858 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2859 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2860
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002861 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2864 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2865 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2866 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2867
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002868 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2869 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2870 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2871 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2872 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2873 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2876 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2877 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002878 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2880
2881 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2882
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002883 Example :
2884 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002885 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002886 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2887 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2888
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002889
2890errorloc <code> <url>
2891errorloc302 <code> <url>
2892 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments :
2896 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002897 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002898
2899 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2900 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2901 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2902 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2903 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2904
2905 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2906 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2907 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2908
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002909 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2910
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002911 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2912 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2913 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2914 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2915 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2916 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2917 request.
2918
2919 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2920
2921
2922errorloc303 <code> <url>
2923 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2925 yes | yes | yes | yes
2926 Arguments :
2927 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2928 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2929
2930 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2931 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2932 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2933 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2934 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2935
2936 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2937 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2938 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2939
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002940 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2941
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002942 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2943 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2944 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2945 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002946 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002947
2948 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2949
2950
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002951email-alert from <emailaddr>
2952 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2953 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2955 yes | yes | yes | yes
2956
2957 Arguments :
2958
2959 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2960
2961 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2962 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2963
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002964 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2965 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2966
2967
2968email-alert level <level>
2969 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2970 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2972 yes | yes | yes | yes
2973
2974 Arguments :
2975
2976 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2977 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2978 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2979
2980 By default level is alert
2981
2982 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2983 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2984 for the proxy.
2985
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002986 Alerts are sent when :
2987
2988 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2989 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2990 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2991 is notice or lower
2992 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2993 and a health check status update occurs
2994
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002995 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2996 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002997 section 3.6 about mailers.
2998
2999
3000email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3001 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3003 yes | yes | yes | yes
3004
3005 Arguments :
3006
3007 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3008
3009 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3010 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3011
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003012 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3013 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003014
3015
3016email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3017 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3018 mailers.
3019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3020 yes | yes | yes | yes
3021
3022 Arguments :
3023
3024 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3025
3026 By default the systems hostname is used.
3027
3028 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3029 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3030 for the proxy.
3031
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003032 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3033 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003034
3035
3036email-alert to <emailaddr>
3037 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3038 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3039 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3040 yes | yes | yes | yes
3041
3042 Arguments :
3043
3044 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3045
3046 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3047 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3048
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003049 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003050 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3051
3052
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003053force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3054 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 no | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3059 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3060 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3061 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3062 marked down for maintenance operations.
3063
3064 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3065 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3066 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3067 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3068 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3069 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3070 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3071 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3072 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3073
3074 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3075 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3076 is used.
3077
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003078 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003079 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003080
3081
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003082fullconn <conns>
3083 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 yes | no | yes | yes
3086 Arguments :
3087 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3088 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3089
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003090 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003091 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003092 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003093 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3094 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3095 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3096 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3097 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003098 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003099
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003100 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3101 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003102 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3103 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3104 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003105
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003106 Example :
3107 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3108 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3109 # connections.
3110 backend dynamic
3111 fullconn 10000
3112 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3113 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3114
3115 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3116
3117
3118grace <time>
3119 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003122 Arguments :
3123 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3124 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3125 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3126
3127 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3128 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003129 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003130 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3131
3132 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3133 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3134 simplify it.
3135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003137hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003138 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | no | yes | yes
3141 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003142 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3143 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003144
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003145 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3146 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3147 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3148 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3149 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3150 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3151 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3152 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3153 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3154 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003155
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003156 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3157 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3158 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3159 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3160 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3161 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3162 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3163 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3164 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3165 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3166 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3167 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3168 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003169 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3170 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003171
3172 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3173
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003174 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003175 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3176 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3177 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003178 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3179 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3180 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003181
3182 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3183 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003184 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3185 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3186 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3187 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3188
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003189 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3190 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3191 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3192 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3193 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3194 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3195 parameter.
3196
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003197 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3198 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3199 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3200 used on strings.
3201
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003202 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3203
3204 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3205 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3206 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3207 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3208 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3209 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3210 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3211 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3212 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3213 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3214 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3215 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003216
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003217 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3218 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3219 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003220
3221 See also : "balance", "server"
3222
3223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224http-check disable-on-404
3225 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003228 Arguments : none
3229
3230 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3231 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3232 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3233 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3234 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3235 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3236 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3237 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003238 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3239 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3240 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3241
3242 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3243
3244
3245http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003246 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003248 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003249 Arguments :
3250 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3251 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003252 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003253 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3254 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3255 details on the supported keywords.
3256
3257 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3258 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3259 with the usual backslash ('\').
3260
3261 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3262 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3263 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3264 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3265 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3266
3267 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003268 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003269 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3270 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3271 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3272
3273 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003274 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003275 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3276 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3277 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3278 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3279
3280 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003281 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003282 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3283 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3284 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3285 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3286 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3287 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3288 trace).
3289
3290 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003291 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003292 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3293 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3294 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3295 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3296 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3297 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3298
3299 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3300 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3301 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3302 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3303 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3304 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3305 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3306 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3307
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003308 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3309 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3310 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3311
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003312 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3313 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3314
3315 Examples :
3316 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003317 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003318
3319 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003320 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003321
3322 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003323 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003324
3325 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003326 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003328 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329
3330
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003331http-check send-state
3332 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 yes | no | yes | yes
3335 Arguments : none
3336
3337 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3338 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3339 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3340 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3341 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3342
3343 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3344 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3345 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3346 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3347 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003348 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3349 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3350 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3351
3352 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3353 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3354 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3355
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003356 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3357 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3358 checked in multiple backends.
3359
3360 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3361 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3362
3363 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3364 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3365 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3366 one fails.
3367
3368 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3369 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3370 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3371
3372 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3373 server's queue.
3374
3375 Example of a header received by the application server :
3376 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3377 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3378
3379 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3380
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003381http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003382 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003383 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003384 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003385 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3386 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003387 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3388 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003389 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3390 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3391 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003392 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003393 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003394 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003395 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003396 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003397 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003398 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003399 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003400 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3401
3402 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3403 no | yes | yes | yes
3404
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003405 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3406 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3407 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3408 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3409 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003410
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003411 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3412 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3413 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3414
3415 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3416 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3417 are evaluated.
3418
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003419 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3420 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3421 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3422 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3423 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3424 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3425 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3426 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3427 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003428 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003429 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3430
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003431 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3432 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3433 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3434 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3435 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3436
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003437 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3438 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3439 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003440 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3441 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003442
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003443 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3444 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3445 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3446 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3447 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3448 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3449 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3450 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3451
3452 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3453 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3454 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003455 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3456 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003457
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003458 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3459 <name>.
3460
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003461 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3462 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3463 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3464 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3465 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3466 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3467 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3468 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3469
3470 Example:
3471
3472 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3473
3474 applied to:
3475
3476 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3477
3478 outputs:
3479
3480 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3481
3482 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3483
3484 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3485 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3486 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3487 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3488 header.
3489
3490 Example:
3491
3492 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3493
3494 applied to:
3495
3496 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3497
3498 outputs:
3499
3500 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3501
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003502 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3503 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3504 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3505 it.
3506
3507 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3508 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3509 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3510 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3511 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3512 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3513
3514 Example :
3515 # prepend the host name before the path
3516 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3517
3518 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3519 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3520 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3521 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3522 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3523 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3524 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3525 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3526
3527 Example :
3528 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3529 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3530
3531 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3532 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3533 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3534 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3535 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3536 "set-query".
3537
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003538 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3539 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3540 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3541 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3542 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3543 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3544 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3545 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3546
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003547 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3548 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3549 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3550 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3551 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3552 another equipment.
3553
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003554 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3555 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3556 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3557 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3558 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3559 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3560 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3561 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3562
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003563 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3564 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3565 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3566 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3567 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3568 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3569 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3570 admin privileges.
3571
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003572 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3573 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3574 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3575 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3576 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3577 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3578 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3579 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3580
3581 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3582 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3583 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3584 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3585 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3586 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3587
3588 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3589 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3590 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3591 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3592 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3593 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3594
3595 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3596 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3597 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3598 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3599 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3600 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3601 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3602 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3603 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3604
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003605 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003606 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3607 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3608 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3609 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3610 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3611 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3612 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3613 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3614 request header" for more information.
3615
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003616 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3617 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3618 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3619 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3620
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003621 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3622 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3623 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3624 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3625 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3626 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3627 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3628 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3629 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3630 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3631 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3632 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3633
3634 These actions take one or two arguments :
3635 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3636 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3637 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3638 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3639
3640 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3641 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3642 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3643 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3644
3645 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3646 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3647 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3648 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3649 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3650 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3651 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3652 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3653
3654 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3655 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3656 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3657 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3658 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3659
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003660 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3661 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3662 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3663 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3664 continues.
3665
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003666 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3667 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3668 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3669 the actions evaluation continues.
3670
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003671 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3672 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3673 function is documented in the API documentation.
3674
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003675 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3676 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3677 inline.
3678
3679 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3680 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3681 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3682 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3683 (request and response)
3684 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3685 processing
3686 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3687 processing.
3688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3689 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3690 and '_'.
3691
3692 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3693 followed by some converters.
3694
3695 Example:
3696
3697 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3698
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003699 - set-src <expr> :
3700 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3701 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3702 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3703 source IP for privacy.
3704
3705 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3706 followed by some converters.
3707
3708 Example:
3709
3710 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3711 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3712
3713 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3714
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003715 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3716
3717 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3718 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3719 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3720 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003721
3722 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003723 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3724 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3725 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003726
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003727 http-request allow if nagios
3728 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3729 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3730 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003731
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003732 Example:
3733 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003734 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003735
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003736 Example:
3737 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3738 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003739 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003740 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3741 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3742 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3743 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3744 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3745 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3746
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003747 Example:
3748 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3749 acl add path /addacl
3750 acl del path /delacl
3751
3752 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3753
3754 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3755 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3756
3757 Example:
3758 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3759 acl setmap path /setmap
3760 acl delmap path /delmap
3761
3762 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3763
3764 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3765 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3766
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003767 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3768 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003769
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003770http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003771 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003772 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003773 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3774 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003775 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003776 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3777 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3778 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3779 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003780 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003781 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003782 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003783 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003784 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003785 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003786 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003787 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3788
3789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 no | yes | yes | yes
3791
3792 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3793 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3794 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3795 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3796 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3797 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3798
3799 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3800 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3801 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3802 current section.
3803
3804 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3805 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3806 rules are evaluated.
3807
3808 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3809 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3810 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3811 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3812 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3813 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3814 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3815
3816 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3817 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3818 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3819 external users.
3820
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003821 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3822 <name>.
3823
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003824 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3825 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3826 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3827 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3828 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3829 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3830 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3831 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3832
3833 Example:
3834
3835 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3836
3837 applied to:
3838
3839 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3840
3841 outputs:
3842
3843 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3844
3845 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3846
3847 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3848 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3849 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3850 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3851 header.
3852
3853 Example:
3854
3855 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3856
3857 applied to:
3858
3859 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3860
3861 outputs:
3862
3863 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3864
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003865 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
3866 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
3867 adapted to the new code.
3868
3869 Example:
3870
3871 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
3872 http-response set-status 431
3873
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003874 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3875 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3876 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3877 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3878 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3879 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3880 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3881 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3882
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003883 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3884 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3885 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3886 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3887 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3888 another equipment.
3889
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003890 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3891 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3892 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3893 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3894 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3895 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3896 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3897 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3898
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003899 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3900 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3901 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3902 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3903 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3904 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3905 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3906 admin privileges.
3907
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003908 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3909 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3910 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3911 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3912 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3913 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3914 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3915 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3916
3917 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3918 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3919 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3920 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3921 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3922 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3923
3924 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3925 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3926 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3927 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3928 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3929 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3930
3931 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3932 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3933 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3934 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3935 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3936 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3937 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3938 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3939 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3940
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003941 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3942 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3943 function is documented in the API documentation.
3944
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003945 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3946 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3947 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3948 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3949 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3950 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3951 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3952 response header" for more information.
3953
3954 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3955 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3956 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3957 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3958 keyword.
3959
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003960 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3961 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3962 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3963 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3964 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3965 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3966
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003967 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3968 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3969 inline.
3970
3971 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3972 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3973 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3974 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3975 (request and response)
3976 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3977 processing
3978 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3979 processing.
3980 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3981 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3982 and '_'.
3983
3984 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3985 followed by some converters.
3986
3987 Example:
3988
3989 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3990
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003991 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3992 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3993 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3994 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3995 continues.
3996
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003997 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3998 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3999 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4000 the actions evaluation continues.
4001
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004002 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4003
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004004 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004005 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
4006 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
4007 rules.
4008
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004009 Example:
4010 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4011
4012 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4013
4014 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4015 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4016
4017 Example:
4018 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4019
4020 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4021
4022 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4023 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4024
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004025 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4026 ACL usage.
4027
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004028
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004029http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4030 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4031
4032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | no | yes | yes
4034
4035 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4036 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4037 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4038 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4039 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4040 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4041
4042 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4043
4044 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4045 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4046 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4047 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4048 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4049 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4050 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4051 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4052 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4053 not checking any request past the first one.
4054
4055 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4056 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4057 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4058 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4059 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4060 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4061 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4062
4063 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4064 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4065 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4066 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4067 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4068 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4069 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4070 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4071 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4072 downsides of rare connection failures.
4073
4074 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4075 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4076 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4077 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4078 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4079 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4080 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4081 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4082 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4083 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4084 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4085 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4086
4087 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4088 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4089 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4090 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4091
4092 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4093 and are never shared ;
4094
4095 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4096 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4097 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4098 and are never shared ;
4099
4100 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4101 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4102 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4103
4104 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4105 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4106 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4107
4108 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4109
4110
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004111http-send-name-header [<header>]
4112 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4113
4114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | no | yes | yes
4116
4117 Arguments :
4118
4119 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4120
4121 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4122 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4123 is added with the header string proved.
4124
4125 See also : "server"
4126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004127id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004128 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 no | yes | yes | yes
4131 Arguments : none
4132
4133 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4134 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4135 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004136
4137
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004138ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4139 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4140 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4141 no | yes | yes | yes
4142
4143 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4144 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4145 and running).
4146
4147 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4148 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4149 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004150 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004151 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4152
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004153 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4154 "unless" condition is met.
4155
4156 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4157
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004158load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4159 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | no | yes | yes
4162
4163 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4164 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4165 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4166 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4167 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4168 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4169 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4170 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4171
4172 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4173 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
4174 9.2).
4175
4176 Arguments:
4177 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4178 named "server-state-file".
4179
4180 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4181 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4182 name is used as a file name.
4183
4184 none don't load any stat for this backend
4185
4186 Notes:
4187 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4188 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4189 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4190
4191 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4192 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4193
4194 Example 1:
4195
4196 Minimal configuration:
4197
4198 global
4199 stats socket /tmp/socket
4200 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4201
4202 defaults
4203 load-server-state-from-file global
4204
4205 backend bk
4206 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4207 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4208
4209 Then one can run :
4210
4211 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4212
4213 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4214
4215 1
4216 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4217 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4218 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4219
4220 Example 2:
4221
4222 Minimal configuration:
4223
4224 global
4225 stats socket /tmp/socket
4226 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4227
4228 defaults
4229 load-server-state-from-file local
4230
4231 backend bk
4232 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4233 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4234
4235 Then one can run :
4236
4237 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4238
4239 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4240
4241 1
4242 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4243 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4244 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4245
4246 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4247 "show servers state"
4248
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004250log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004251log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004252no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004253 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004256
4257 Prefix :
4258 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4259 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4260 prefix does not allow arguments.
4261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004262 Arguments :
4263 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4264 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4265 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4266 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4267 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4268 parameter.
4269
4270 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4271 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4272
4273 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4274 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4275 standard syslog port).
4276
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004277 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4278 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4279 standard syslog port).
4280
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004281 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4282 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4283 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4284 appropriately writeable).
4285
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004286 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4287 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004288
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004289 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4290 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4291 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4292 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4293 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4294 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4295 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4296 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4297 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4298 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4299 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4300
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004301 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4302
4303 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4304 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4305 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4306
4307 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4308 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4309 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004310 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4311 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4312 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4313 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4314 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004315
4316 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4317
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004318 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4319 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4320 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004321
4322 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4323 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4324 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4325 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4326
4327 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4328 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004329
4330 Example :
4331 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004332 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4333 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004334 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004335
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004336
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004337log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004338 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004341
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004342 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4343 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4344 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4345 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4346 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004347
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004348log-tag <string>
4349 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4351 yes | yes | yes | yes
4352
4353 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4354 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4355 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4356 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4357 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4358 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4359 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4360 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4361 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004362
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004363max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4364 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 yes | no | yes | yes
4367
4368 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4369 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4370 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4371 servers.
4372
4373 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4374 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4375 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4376 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4377 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4378 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4379 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4380 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4381 picking a different server.
4382
4383 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4384 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4385 even if they have to be queued.
4386
4387 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4388 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4389
4390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004391maxconn <conns>
4392 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | yes | yes | no
4395 Arguments :
4396 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4397 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4398 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4399 closes.
4400
4401 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4402 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4403 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4404 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4405 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4406 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4407 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4408 properly tuned.
4409
4410 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4411 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4412 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4413
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004414 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4415
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004416 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4417
4418
4419mode { tcp|http|health }
4420 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | yes
4423 Arguments :
4424 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4425 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4426 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4427 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4428
4429 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4430 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4431 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4432 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4433 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4434
4435 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004436 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4437 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4438 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4439 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4440 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4441 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4442 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004443
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004444 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4445 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4446 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004447
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004448 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004449 defaults http_instances
4450 mode http
4451
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004452 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004454
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004455monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4458 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004459 Arguments :
4460 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4461 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004462 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4464 backend and its backup.
4465
4466 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4467 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4468 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4469 servers in a list of backends.
4470
4471 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4472 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4473 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4474 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4475 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4476 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4477 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004478 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4479 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004480
4481 Example:
4482 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004483 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004484 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4485 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4486 monitor-uri /site_alive
4487 monitor fail if site_dead
4488
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004489 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490
4491
4492monitor-net <source>
4493 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 yes | yes | yes | no
4496 Arguments :
4497 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4498 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4499 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4500 followed by a mask.
4501
4502 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4503 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004504 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004505 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4506
4507 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4508 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4509 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4510 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004511 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4512 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4513 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004514
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004515 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4516 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4517 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4518 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4519 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4520 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004521
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004522 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4523 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004524
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004525 Example :
4526 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4527 frontend www
4528 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4529
4530 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4531
4532
4533monitor-uri <uri>
4534 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4536 yes | yes | yes | no
4537 Arguments :
4538 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4539 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4540
4541 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4542 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4543 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4544 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4545 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4546 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4547 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4548 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4549
4550 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4551 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4552 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4553 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4554 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4555 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4556
4557 Example :
4558 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4559 frontend www
4560 mode http
4561 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4562
4563 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004565
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004566option abortonclose
4567no option abortonclose
4568 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | no | yes | yes
4571 Arguments : none
4572
4573 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4574 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4575 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4576 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004577 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004578 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4579 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4580 encountered while delivering the response.
4581
4582 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4583 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4584 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4585 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4586 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4587 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004588 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004589 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004590 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004591 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4592 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4593 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4594
4595 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4596 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4597 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4598 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4599 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4600 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4601 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4602 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004603 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004604
4605 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4606 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4607
4608 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4609
4610
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004611option accept-invalid-http-request
4612no option accept-invalid-http-request
4613 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4615 yes | yes | yes | no
4616 Arguments : none
4617
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004618 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004619 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4620 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4621 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4622 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4623 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4624 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4625 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004626 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4627 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4628 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4629 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4630 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004631 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004632 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4633 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4634 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004635
4636 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4637 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4638 been confirmed.
4639
4640 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4641 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004642 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4643 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004644 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4645
4646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4648
4649 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4650 stats socket.
4651
4652
4653option accept-invalid-http-response
4654no option accept-invalid-http-response
4655 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4657 yes | no | yes | yes
4658 Arguments : none
4659
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004660 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004661 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4662 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4663 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4664 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4665 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4666 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4667 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004668 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4669 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4670 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004671
4672 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4673 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4674 been confirmed.
4675
4676 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4677 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4678 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4679 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4680
4681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4683
4684 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4685 stats socket.
4686
4687
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004688option allbackups
4689no option allbackups
4690 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4692 yes | no | yes | yes
4693 Arguments : none
4694
4695 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4696 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4697 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4698 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4699 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4700 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4701 order between the backup servers anymore.
4702
4703 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4704 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4705
4706 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4707 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4708
4709
4710option checkcache
4711no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004712 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | no | yes | yes
4715 Arguments : none
4716
4717 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4718 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004719 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004720 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4721 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004722 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004723
4724 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004725 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004726 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004727 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4728 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004729 to the client are :
4730 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004731 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004732 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004733 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4734 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4735 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4736 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4737 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4738 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4739 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4740 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4741 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4742 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4743 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4744
4745 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004746 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004747 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004748 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004749 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4750
4751 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4752 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004753 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004754 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4755
4756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4758
4759
4760option clitcpka
4761no option clitcpka
4762 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | yes | yes | no
4765 Arguments : none
4766
4767 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4768 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4769 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4770 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4771
4772 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4773 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4774 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4775 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4776
4777 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4778 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4779 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4780 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4781 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4782
4783 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4784
4785 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4786 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4787 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4788
4789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4791
4792 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4793
4794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004795option contstats
4796 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | yes | yes | no
4799 Arguments : none
4800
4801 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4802 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4803 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4804 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4805 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4806 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4807 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4808
4809
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004810option dontlog-normal
4811no option dontlog-normal
4812 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | yes | yes | no
4815 Arguments : none
4816
4817 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4818 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4819 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4820 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4821 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4822 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4823 logged.
4824
4825 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4826 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4827 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004829 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004830 logging.
4831
4832
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004833option dontlognull
4834no option dontlognull
4835 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | yes | yes | no
4838 Arguments : none
4839
4840 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4841 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4842 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4843 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4844 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4845 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004846 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4847 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4848 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004849
4850 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4851 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4852 would not be logged.
4853
4854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4856
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004857 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4858 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004859
4860
4861option forceclose
4862no option forceclose
4863 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004866 Arguments : none
4867
4868 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4869 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4870 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4871 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4872 global session times in the logs.
4873
4874 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004875 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004876 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004877
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004878 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4879 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4880 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4881
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004882 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4883 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004884
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4887
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004888 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004889
4890
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004891option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004892 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | yes | yes | yes
4895 Arguments :
4896 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4897 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004898 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004899 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004900
4901 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4902 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4903 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4904 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4905 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4906 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4907 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004908 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4909 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4910 possible that the client has already brought one.
4911
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004912 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004913 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004914 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4915 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004916 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4917 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004918
4919 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4920 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4921 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4922 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4923 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4924 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4925 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4926
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004927 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4928 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4929 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4930 are under the control of the end-user.
4931
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004932 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004933 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4934 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004935 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4936 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4937 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004938
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004939 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004940 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4941 frontend www
4942 mode http
4943 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4944
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004945 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4946 backend www
4947 mode http
4948 option forwardfor header X-Client
4949
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004950 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004951 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004952
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004953
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004954option http-buffer-request
4955no option http-buffer-request
4956 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | yes
4959 Arguments : none
4960
4961 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4962 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4963 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4964 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4965 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4966 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4967 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4968 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4969 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4970 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4971 default.
4972
4973 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4974
4975
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004976option http-ignore-probes
4977no option http-ignore-probes
4978 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | yes | yes | no
4981 Arguments : none
4982
4983 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4984 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4985 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4986 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4987 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4988 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4989 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4990 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4991 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4992 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4993 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4994 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4995
4996 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4997 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4998 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4999 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5000 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5001 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5002 are often the only way to detect them.
5003
5004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5006
5007 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5008
5009
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005010option http-keep-alive
5011no option http-keep-alive
5012 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | yes | yes | yes
5015 Arguments : none
5016
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005017 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5018 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5019 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5020 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5021 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5022 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5023 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5024
5025 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5026 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005027 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5028 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5029 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5030 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5031 situations where this option may be useful :
5032
5033 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5034 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5035
5036 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5037 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5038
5039 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5040 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5041 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5042 request.
5043
5044 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5045 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005046 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5047 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5048 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005049
5050 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5051 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5052
5053 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5054 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5055 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5056 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5057 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5058 not set.
5059
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005060 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5061 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005062 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005063 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005064
5065 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005066 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5067 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005068
5069
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005070option http-no-delay
5071no option http-no-delay
5072 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5074 yes | yes | yes | yes
5075 Arguments : none
5076
5077 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5078 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5079 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5080 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5081 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5082 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5083 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5084 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5085 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5086 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5087 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5088 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5089 affected.
5090
5091 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5092 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5093 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5094 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5095 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5096 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5097 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5098 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5099 latency environments.
5100
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005101 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5102
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005103
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005104option http-pretend-keepalive
5105no option http-pretend-keepalive
5106 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5108 yes | yes | yes | yes
5109 Arguments : none
5110
5111 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5112 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5113 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5114 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5115 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5116 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5117 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5118 consider the response complete.
5119
5120 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5121 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5122 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5123 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5124 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5125 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5126
5127 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5128 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5129 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5130 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5131 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5132 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5133 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5134
5135 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5136 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005137 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005138 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5139 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005140
5141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5143
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005144 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5145 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005146
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005147
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005148option http-server-close
5149no option http-server-close
5150 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | yes | yes | yes
5153 Arguments : none
5154
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005155 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5156 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5157 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5158 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5159 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5160 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5161 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5162 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5163 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5164 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5165 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5166 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5167 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5168 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5169 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5170 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005171
5172 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5173 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5174 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5175 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005176 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5177 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005178
5179 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5180 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005181 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5182 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005183 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5184 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005185
5186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5188
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005189 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005190 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5191 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005192
5193
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005194option http-tunnel
5195no option http-tunnel
5196 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | yes | yes | yes
5199 Arguments : none
5200
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005201 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5202 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5203 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5204 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5205 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5206 "option http-tunnel".
5207
5208 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005209 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005210 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5211 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5212 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5213 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5214 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5215 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5216 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005217
5218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5220
5221 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5222 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5223 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5224
5225
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005226option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005227no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005228 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5230 yes | yes | yes | no
5231 Arguments : none
5232
5233 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5234 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5235 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5236 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5237 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5238 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5239 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5240
5241 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5242 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5243 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5244 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5245 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5246 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5247 request along its whole life.
5248
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005249 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5250 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5251 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5252 front of an existing proxy.
5253
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005254 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5255
5256 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5257 http-server-close".
5258
5259
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005260option httpchk
5261option httpchk <uri>
5262option httpchk <method> <uri>
5263option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5264 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | no | yes | yes
5267 Arguments :
5268 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5269 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5270 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5271 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5272 ones.
5273
5274 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5275 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5276 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5277
5278 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5279 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5280 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5281 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5282 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5283
5284 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5285 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5286 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5287 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5288 the lack of any response.
5289
5290 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5291
5292 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5293 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5294 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5295
5296 Examples :
5297 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5298 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5299 backend https_relay
5300 mode tcp
5301 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5302 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5303
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005304 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5305 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5306 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005307
5308
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005309option httpclose
5310no option httpclose
5311 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5313 yes | yes | yes | yes
5314 Arguments : none
5315
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005316 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5317 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5318 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5319 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005320 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005321 "option http-tunnel".
5322
5323 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5324 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5325 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5326 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5327 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5328 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5329 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5330 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005331
5332 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005333 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005334 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5335 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5336 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5337 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5338 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005339
5340 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5341 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005342 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5343 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005344 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5345 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005346
5347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5349
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005350 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5351 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005352
5353
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005354option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005355 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5357 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005358 Arguments :
5359 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5360 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5361 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5362 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5363 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005364
5365 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5366 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5367 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5368 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5369 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5370 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5371 ports.
5372
5373 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5374
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005375 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5376 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005378 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005379
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005380
5381option http_proxy
5382no option http_proxy
5383 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | yes | yes | yes
5386 Arguments : none
5387
5388 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5389 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5390 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5391 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5392 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5393
5394 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5395 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5396 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5397 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005398 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005399 be analyzed.
5400
5401 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5402 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5403
5404 Example :
5405 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5406 backend direct_forward
5407 option httpclose
5408 option http_proxy
5409
5410 See also : "option httpclose"
5411
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005412
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005413option independent-streams
5414no option independent-streams
5415 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | yes | yes | yes
5418 Arguments : none
5419
5420 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5421 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5422 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5423 receive data or not.
5424
5425 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5426 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5427 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5428 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5429 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5430 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5431 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5432 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5433 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5434 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5435 socket buffers.
5436
5437 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5438 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5439 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5440 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5441 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5442
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005443 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005444 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5445 deprecated.
5446
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005447 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005448
5449
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005450option ldap-check
5451 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5453 yes | no | yes | yes
5454 Arguments : none
5455
5456 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5457 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5458 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5459 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5460
5461 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5462 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5463
5464 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5465 configure it.
5466
5467 Example :
5468 option ldap-check
5469
5470 See also : "option httpchk"
5471
5472
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005473option external-check
5474 Use external processes for server health checks
5475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 yes | no | yes | yes
5477
5478 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5479 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5480 command".
5481
5482 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5483
5484 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5485
5486
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005487option log-health-checks
5488no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005489 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5491 yes | no | yes | yes
5492 Arguments : none
5493
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005494 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5495 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5496 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005497
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005498 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5499 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5500 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5501 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5502 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5503
5504 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5505 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005506
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005507 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5508 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5509 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005510
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005511
5512option log-separate-errors
5513no option log-separate-errors
5514 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5516 yes | yes | yes | no
5517 Arguments : none
5518
5519 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5520 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5521 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5522 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5523 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5524 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5525 provides very important information.
5526
5527 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5528 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5529 error logs.
5530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005531 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005532 logging.
5533
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005534
5535option logasap
5536no option logasap
5537 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | yes | yes | no
5540 Arguments : none
5541
5542 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5543 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5544 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5545 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5546 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5547 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5548 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005549 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005550 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5551 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5552
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005553 Examples :
5554 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5555 mode http
5556 option httplog
5557 option logasap
5558 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5559
5560 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5561 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5562 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5563 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005565 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005566 logging.
5567
5568
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005569option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005570 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5572 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005573 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005574 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5575 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005576 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005577
5578 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5579 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5580 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5581 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5582 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5583 in the MySQL table, like this :
5584
5585 USE mysql;
5586 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5587 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5588
5589 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5590 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5591 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5592 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5593 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5594 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5595 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5596 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5597 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5598
5599 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5600 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005601
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005602 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005603
5604 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5605 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5606 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5607 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005608 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5609 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005610
5611 See also: "option httpchk"
5612
5613
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005614option nolinger
5615no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005616 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005619 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005620
5621 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5622 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5623 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5624 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5625 connections.
5626
5627 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5628 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5629 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5630 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5631 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5632 this too.
5633
5634 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5635 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5636 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5637
5638 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5639 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5640 for servers.
5641
5642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5644
5645
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005646option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5647 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5649 yes | yes | yes | yes
5650 Arguments :
5651 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5652 matching <network>
5653 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5654 header name.
5655
5656 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5657 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5658 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5659 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5660 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5661 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5662 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5663 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5664 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5665 possible that the client has already brought one.
5666
5667 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5668 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5669 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5670 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5671 header and requires different one.
5672
5673 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5674 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5675 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5676 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5677 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5678 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5679 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5680
5681 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5682 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5683 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5684 both are defined.
5685
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005686 Examples :
5687 # Original Destination address
5688 frontend www
5689 mode http
5690 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5691
5692 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5693 backend www
5694 mode http
5695 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5696
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005697 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5698 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005699
5700
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005701option persist
5702no option persist
5703 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005706 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005707
5708 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5709 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5710 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5711 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5712 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5713 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5714 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5715 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5716 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5717 redirected to another valid server.
5718
5719 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5720 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5721
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005722 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005723
5724
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005725option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5726 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5728 yes | no | yes | yes
5729 Arguments :
5730 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5731 PostgreSQL server.
5732
5733 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5734 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5735 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5736 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5737
5738 See also: "option httpchk"
5739
5740
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005741option prefer-last-server
5742no option prefer-last-server
5743 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | no | yes | yes
5746 Arguments : none
5747
5748 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5749 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5750 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5751 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5752 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5753 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5754 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5755 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5756 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005757 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5758 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5759 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5760 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5761 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5762 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5763 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005764
5765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5767
5768 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5769
5770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005771option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005772option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005773no option redispatch
5774 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5775 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005777 Arguments :
5778 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5779 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5780 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5781 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5782 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5783 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5784 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5785 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5786 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005788
5789 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5790 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5791 be able to access the service anymore.
5792
5793 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5794 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5795
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005796 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005797 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5798 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005800 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5801 "redisp" keywords.
5802
5803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5805
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005806 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005807
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005808
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005809option redis-check
5810 Use redis health checks for server testing
5811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813 Arguments : none
5814
5815 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5816 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5817 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5818 find the "+PONG" response message.
5819
5820 Example :
5821 option redis-check
5822
5823 See also : "option httpchk"
5824
5825
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005826option smtpchk
5827option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5828 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5830 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005831 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005832 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5833 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5834 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5835
5836 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5837 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5838 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5839
5840 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5841 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5842 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5843 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5844 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5845 dead server.
5846
5847 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5848 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5849 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5850 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5851
5852 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5853 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5854 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5855 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005856 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005857
5858 Example :
5859 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5860
5861 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005864option socket-stats
5865no option socket-stats
5866
5867 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 yes | yes | yes | no
5870
5871 Arguments : none
5872
5873
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005874option splice-auto
5875no option splice-auto
5876 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 yes | yes | yes | yes
5879 Arguments : none
5880
5881 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5882 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5883 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5884 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005885 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005886 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5887 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5888 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5889 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5890
5891 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5892 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5893 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5894 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5895 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5896 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5897 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5898 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5899 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5900 keyword.
5901
5902 Example :
5903 option splice-auto
5904
5905 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5906 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5907
5908 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5909 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5910
5911
5912option splice-request
5913no option splice-request
5914 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | yes | yes | yes
5917 Arguments : none
5918
5919 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005920 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005921 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5922 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5923 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5924 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5925
5926 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5927
5928 Example :
5929 option splice-request
5930
5931 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5932 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5933
5934 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5935 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5936
5937
5938option splice-response
5939no option splice-response
5940 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5942 yes | yes | yes | yes
5943 Arguments : none
5944
5945 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005946 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005947 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5948 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5949 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5950 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5951
5952 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5953
5954 Example :
5955 option splice-response
5956
5957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5959
5960 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5961 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5962
5963
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005964option srvtcpka
5965no option srvtcpka
5966 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5968 yes | no | yes | yes
5969 Arguments : none
5970
5971 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5972 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5973 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5974 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5975
5976 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5977 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5978 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5979 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5980
5981 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5982 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5983 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5984 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5985 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5986
5987 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5988
5989 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5990 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5991 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5992
5993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5995
5996 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5997
5998
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005999option ssl-hello-chk
6000 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6002 yes | no | yes | yes
6003 Arguments : none
6004
6005 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6006 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6007 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6008 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6009 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6010 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6011 hello message.
6012
6013 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6014 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6015 messages, which is appreciable.
6016
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006017 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6018 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6019 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006020
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006021 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6022
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006023
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006024option tcp-check
6025 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6026 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 yes | no | yes | yes
6028
6029 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6030 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6031
6032 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6033 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6034 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6035
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006036 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006037 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6038 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6039 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6040 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6041 only.
6042
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006043 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006044 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6045 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6046 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6047 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006049 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006050 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6051 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006052 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006053 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6054 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6055 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6056 the respective protocols.
6057 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6058 analysed.
6059
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006060 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6061 script.
6062
6063 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6064 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6065 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6066 The "comment" is of course optional.
6067
6068
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006069 Examples :
6070 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6071 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006072 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006073
6074 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6075 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006076 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006077
6078 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6079 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006080 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006081 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006082 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006083 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006084 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006085 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006086 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6087 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006088 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006089 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6090 tcp-check expect string +OK
6091
6092 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6093 (send many headers before analyzing)
6094 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006095 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006096 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6097 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6098 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6099 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006100 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006101
6102
6103 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6104
6105
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006106option tcp-smart-accept
6107no option tcp-smart-accept
6108 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6110 yes | yes | yes | no
6111 Arguments : none
6112
6113 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6114 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6115 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6116 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6117 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6118 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6119
6120 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6121 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6122 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6123 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6124
6125 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6126 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6127 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6128 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6129
6130 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6131 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6132 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6133
6134 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6135 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6136 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6137
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006138 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6139
6140
6141option tcp-smart-connect
6142no option tcp-smart-connect
6143 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6145 yes | no | yes | yes
6146 Arguments : none
6147
6148 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6149 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6150 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6151 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6152 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6153
6154 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6155 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6156 complex.
6157
6158 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6159 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6160 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6161
6162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6164
6165 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6166
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006167
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006168option tcpka
6169 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6171 yes | yes | yes | yes
6172 Arguments : none
6173
6174 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6175 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6176 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6177 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6178
6179 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6180 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6181 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6182 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6183
6184 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6185 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6186 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6187 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6188 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6189
6190 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6191
6192 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6193 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6194 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6195 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6196 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6197 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6198 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6199 backends.
6200
6201 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6202
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006203
6204option tcplog
6205 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6207 yes | yes | yes | yes
6208 Arguments : none
6209
6210 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6211 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6212 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6213 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6214 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6215 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6216 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6217 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6218
6219 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006221 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006222
6223
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006224option transparent
6225no option transparent
6226 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006228 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006229 Arguments : none
6230
6231 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6232 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6233 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6234 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6235 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6236 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6237 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6238 appropriate server.
6239
6240 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6241 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6242
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006243 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006244 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006245
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006246
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006247external-check command <command>
6248 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6250 yes | no | yes | yes
6251
6252 Arguments :
6253 <command> is the external command to run
6254
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006255 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6256
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006257 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006258
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006259 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6260 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6261 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6262 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6263 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6264 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006265
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006266 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6267
6268 Environment variables :
6269 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6270 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6271
6272 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6273
6274 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6275
6276 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6277 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6278 for a UNIX socket).
6279
6280 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6281
6282 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6283
6284 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6285
6286 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6287
6288 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6289
6290 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6291 socket).
6292
6293 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6294 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6295
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006296 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6297 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6298 failed.
6299
6300 Example :
6301 external-check command /bin/true
6302
6303 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6304
6305
6306external-check path <path>
6307 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6309 yes | no | yes | yes
6310
6311 Arguments :
6312 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6313
6314 The default path is "".
6315
6316 Example :
6317 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6318
6319 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6320 "external-check command"
6321
6322
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006323persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006324persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006325 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6327 yes | no | yes | yes
6328 Arguments :
6329 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006330 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6331 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006332
6333 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6334 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6335 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6336 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6337 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6338 forwarded to this server.
6339
6340 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6341 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6342 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006343 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006344 a single "listen" section.
6345
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006346 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6347 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6348 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6349
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006350 Example :
6351 listen tse-farm
6352 bind :3389
6353 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6354 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6355 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6356 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6357 persist rdp-cookie
6358 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006359 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006360 balance rdp-cookie
6361 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6362 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6363
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006364 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6365 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006366
6367
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006368rate-limit sessions <rate>
6369 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6371 yes | yes | yes | no
6372 Arguments :
6373 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6374 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6375
6376 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6377 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6378 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6379 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6380 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6381 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6382
6383 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6384 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6385 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6386 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6387
6388 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6389 listen smtp
6390 mode tcp
6391 bind :25
6392 rate-limit sessions 10
6393 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6394
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006395 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6396 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6397 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006398
6399 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6400
6401
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006402redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6403redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6404redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006405 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6407 no | yes | yes | yes
6408
6409 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006410 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006411
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006412 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006413 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006414 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6415 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6416 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006417
6418 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6419 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6420 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6421 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6422 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006423 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6424 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6425 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6426 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006427
6428 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6429 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6430 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6431 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6432 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6433 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006434 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006435 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006436 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6437 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6438 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006439
6440 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006441 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6442 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6443 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006444 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006445 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6446 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6447 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6448 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006449
6450 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6451 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6452
6453 - "drop-query"
6454 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6455 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6456 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6457 with a location-type redirect.
6458
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006459 - "append-slash"
6460 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6461 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6462 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6463 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6464
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006465 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6466 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6467 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6468 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6469 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6470 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6471 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6472
6473 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6474 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6475 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6476 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6477 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6478 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6479 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006480
6481 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6482 acl clear dst_port 80
6483 acl secure dst_port 8080
6484 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006485 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006486 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006487 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6488
6489 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006490 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6491 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6492 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006493 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006494
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006495 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6496 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6497 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6498
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006499 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006500 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006501
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006502 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6503 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6504 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006506 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006507
6508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006509redisp (deprecated)
6510redispatch (deprecated)
6511 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6513 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006514 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006515
6516 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6517 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6518 be able to access the service anymore.
6519
6520 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6521 redistribute them to a working server.
6522
6523 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6524 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6525 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006527 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6528 "option redispatch" instead.
6529
6530 See also : "option redispatch"
6531
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006532
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006533reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006534 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 no | yes | yes | yes
6537 Arguments :
6538 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6539 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006540 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006541
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006542 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6543 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6544
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006545 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6546 the last header of an HTTP request.
6547
6548 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6549 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6550 responses.
6551
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006552 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6553 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6554 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6555
6556 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6557 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006558
6559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006560reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6561reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006562 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6564 no | yes | yes | yes
6565 Arguments :
6566 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6567 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6568 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6569 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6570 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6571 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6572 ignores case.
6573
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006574 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6575 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6576
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006577 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6578 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6579 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6580 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006581 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006582
6583 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6584 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6585
6586 Example :
6587 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6588 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6589 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6590
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006591 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6592 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006593
6594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006595reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6596reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006597 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 no | yes | yes | yes
6600 Arguments :
6601 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6602 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6603 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6604 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6605 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6606 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6607
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006611 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6612 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6613 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6614 next servers.
6615
6616 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6617 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6618 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6619
6620 Example :
6621 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6622 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6623 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6624
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006625 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6626 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006627
6628
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006629reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6630reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006631 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 no | yes | yes | yes
6634 Arguments :
6635 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6636 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6637 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6638 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6639 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6640 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6641 case.
6642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006643 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6644 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6645
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006646 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6647 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6648 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6649 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006650 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006651
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006652 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006653 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006654 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006655
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006656 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6657 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6658
6659 Example :
6660 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6661 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6662 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6663
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006664 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6665 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006666
6667
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006668reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6669reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006670 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 no | yes | yes | yes
6673 Arguments :
6674 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6675 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6676 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6677 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6678 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6679 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6680 case.
6681
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006682 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6683 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6684
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006685 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6686 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6687 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6688 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6689
6690 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6691 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6692
6693 Example :
6694 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6695 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6696 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6697 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6698
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006699 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6700 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006701
6702
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006703reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6704reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006705 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 no | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments :
6709 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6710 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6711 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6712 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6713 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6714 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6715
6716 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6717 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6718 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6719 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006720 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006725 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6726 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6727 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6728
6729 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6730 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6731 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6732 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6733 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6734
6735 Example :
6736 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006737 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006738 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6739 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6740
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006741 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6742 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006743
6744
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006745reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6746reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006747 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 no | yes | yes | yes
6750 Arguments :
6751 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6752 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6753 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6754 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6755 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6756 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6757 ignores case.
6758
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006759 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6760 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6761
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006762 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6763 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006764 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6765 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6766 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006767 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6768 not set.
6769
6770 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6771 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6772 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6773 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6774 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006776 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006777 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6778 # block all others.
6779 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6780 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6781
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006782 # block bad guys
6783 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6784 reqitarpit . if badguys
6785
6786 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6787 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006788
6789
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006790retries <value>
6791 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6793 yes | no | yes | yes
6794 Arguments :
6795 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6796 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6797 default value is 3.
6798
6799 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6800 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6801 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6802
6803 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006804 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6805 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006806
6807 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6808 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6809
6810 See also : "option redispatch"
6811
6812
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006813rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006814 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 no | yes | yes | yes
6817 Arguments :
6818 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6819 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006820 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006821
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006822 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6823 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6824
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006825 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6826 the last header of an HTTP response.
6827
6828 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6829 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6830 responses.
6831
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006832 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6833 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006834
6835
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006836rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6837rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006838 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 no | yes | yes | yes
6841 Arguments :
6842 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6843 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6844 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6845 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6846 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6847 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6848 ignores case.
6849
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006850 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6851 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6852
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006853 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6854 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006855 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006856 client.
6857
6858 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6859 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6860 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6861
6862 Example :
6863 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006864 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006865
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006866 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6867 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006868
6869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006870rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6871rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006872 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6874 no | yes | yes | yes
6875 Arguments :
6876 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6877 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6878 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6879 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6880 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6881 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6882 ignores case.
6883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006884 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6885 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6886
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006887 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6888 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6889 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6890 case-sensitive.
6891
6892 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006893 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6894 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6895 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006896
6897 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6898 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6899
6900 Example :
6901 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6902 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6903
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006904 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6905 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006906
6907
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006908rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6909rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006910 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 no | yes | yes | yes
6913 Arguments :
6914 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6915 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6916 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6917 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6918 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6919 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6920 ignores case.
6921
6922 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6923 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6924 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6925 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006926 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006927
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006928 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6929 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6930
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006931 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6932 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6933 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6934
6935 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6936 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6937 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6938 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6939 are not case-sensitive.
6940
6941 Example :
6942 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6943 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6944
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006945 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6946 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006947
6948
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006949server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006950 Declare a server in a backend
6951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 no | no | yes | yes
6953 Arguments :
6954 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006955 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006956 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006957
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006958 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6959 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6960 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6961 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006962 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6963 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6964 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6965 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6966 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006967 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6968 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6969 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6970 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6971 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6972 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6973 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006974 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006975 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6976 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6977 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006978
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006979 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006980 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6981 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6982 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6983 adding this value to the client's port.
6984
6985 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6986 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006987 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006988
6989 Examples :
6990 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6991 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006992 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006993 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6994 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6995 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006996
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02006997 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
6998 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
6999 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7000 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7001 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7002
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007003 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7004 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007005
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007006server-state-file-name [<file>]
7007 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7008 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7009 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7010 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7011 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7012 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7013
7014 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7015 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7016
7017 global
7018 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7019
7020 backend bk
7021 load-server-state-from-file
7022
7023 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7024 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007025
7026source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007027source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007028source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007029 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7031 yes | no | yes | yes
7032 Arguments :
7033 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7034 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007035
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007036 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007037 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7038 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7039 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7040 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7041 supported prefixes are :
7042 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7043 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7044 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007045 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007046 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
7047 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007048
7049 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7050 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007051 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7052 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7053 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007054
7055 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7056 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7057 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7058 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7059 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7060 <addr>.
7061
7062 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7063 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7064 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7065 port.
7066
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007067 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7068 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7069 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7070 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007071 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007072 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7073 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7074 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7075 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7076 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7077 HTTP header.
7078
7079 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7080 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007081 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007082 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7083 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7084 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7085 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7086 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7087 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7088 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7089
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007090 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7091 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7092 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7093 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7094 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7095 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7096
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007097 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7098 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7099 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7100 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7101
7102 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7103 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7104 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7105 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7106 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7107 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7108
7109 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7110 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7111 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7112 there are two methods :
7113
7114 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7115 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7116 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7117 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7118 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7119 of the client ranges may be used.
7120
7121 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7122 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7123 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7124 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7125 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7126 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7127 same session.
7128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007129 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7130 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7131 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007132 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007133
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007134 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7135
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007136 Examples :
7137 backend private
7138 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7139 source 192.168.1.200
7140
7141 backend transparent_ssl1
7142 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7143 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7144
7145 backend transparent_ssl2
7146 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7147 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7148 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7149
7150 backend transparent_ssl3
7151 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7152 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7153 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7154
7155 backend transparent_smtp
7156 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7157 # with Tproxy version 4.
7158 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7159
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007160 backend transparent_http
7161 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7162 # proxy.
7163 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007165 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007166 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007168
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007169srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7170 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7172 yes | no | yes | yes
7173 Arguments :
7174 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7175 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7176 as explained at the top of this document.
7177
7178 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7179 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7180 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7181 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7182 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7183 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7184 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7185
7186 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7187 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7188 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7189 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7190 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007191 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007192 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007193 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007194
7195 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7196 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7197 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7198 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7199 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7200 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7201
7202 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7203 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7204
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007205 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7206 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007207
7208
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007209stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7210 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007212 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007213
7214 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7215 matched.
7216
7217 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7218 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7219
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007220 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7221 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7222 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7223
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007224 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7225 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7226 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7227 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007228
7229 Example :
7230 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7231 backend stats_localhost
7232 stats enable
7233 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7234
7235 Example :
7236 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7237 backend stats_auth
7238 stats enable
7239 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7240 stats admin if TRUE
7241
7242 Example :
7243 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7244 userlist stats-auth
7245 group admin users admin
7246 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7247 group readonly users haproxy
7248 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7249
7250 backend stats_auth
7251 stats enable
7252 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7253 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7254 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7255 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7256
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007257 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7258 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7259 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007260
7261
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007262stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7263 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007266 Arguments :
7267 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7268
7269 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7270
7271 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7272 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7273 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7274 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7275 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7276 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7277
7278 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7279 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7280 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007281 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007282
7283 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7284 report using "stats scope".
7285
7286 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7287 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7288 unobvious parameters.
7289
7290 Example :
7291 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7292 backend public_www
7293 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7294 stats enable
7295 stats hide-version
7296 stats scope .
7297 stats uri /admin?stats
7298 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7299 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7300 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7301
7302 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7303 backend private_monitoring
7304 stats enable
7305 stats uri /admin?stats
7306 stats refresh 5s
7307
7308 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7309
7310
7311stats enable
7312 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007314 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007315 Arguments : none
7316
7317 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7318 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7319 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7320 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7321 - stats auth : no authentication
7322 - stats scope : no restriction
7323
7324 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7325 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7326 unobvious parameters.
7327
7328 Example :
7329 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7330 backend public_www
7331 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7332 stats enable
7333 stats hide-version
7334 stats scope .
7335 stats uri /admin?stats
7336 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7337 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7338 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7339
7340 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7341 backend private_monitoring
7342 stats enable
7343 stats uri /admin?stats
7344 stats refresh 5s
7345
7346 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7347
7348
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007349stats hide-version
7350 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007352 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007353 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007354
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007355 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7356 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7357 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7358 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7359 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7360 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007362 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7363 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7364 unobvious parameters.
7365
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007366 Example :
7367 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7368 backend public_www
7369 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007370 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007371 stats hide-version
7372 stats scope .
7373 stats uri /admin?stats
7374 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7375 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7376 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007377
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007378 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7379 backend private_monitoring
7380 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007381 stats uri /admin?stats
7382 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007383
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007384 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007385
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007386
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007387stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7388 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7389 Access control for statistics
7390
7391 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 no | no | yes | yes
7393
7394 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7395 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7396 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7397 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7398 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7399 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7400
7401 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7402 instance.
7403
7404 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7405 about ACL usage.
7406
7407
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007408stats realm <realm>
7409 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007411 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007412 Arguments :
7413 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7414 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7415 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7416
7417 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7418 using a backslash ('\').
7419
7420 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7421 only related to authentication.
7422
7423 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7424 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7425 unobvious parameters.
7426
7427 Example :
7428 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7429 backend public_www
7430 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7431 stats enable
7432 stats hide-version
7433 stats scope .
7434 stats uri /admin?stats
7435 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7436 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7437 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7438
7439 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7440 backend private_monitoring
7441 stats enable
7442 stats uri /admin?stats
7443 stats refresh 5s
7444
7445 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7446
7447
7448stats refresh <delay>
7449 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007451 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007452 Arguments :
7453 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7454 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7455 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7456 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7457 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7458 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7459
7460 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7461 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7462 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7463 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7464
7465 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7466 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7467 unobvious parameters.
7468
7469 Example :
7470 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7471 backend public_www
7472 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7473 stats enable
7474 stats hide-version
7475 stats scope .
7476 stats uri /admin?stats
7477 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7478 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7479 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7480
7481 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7482 backend private_monitoring
7483 stats enable
7484 stats uri /admin?stats
7485 stats refresh 5s
7486
7487 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7488
7489
7490stats scope { <name> | "." }
7491 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007493 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007494 Arguments :
7495 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7496 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7497 section in which the statement appears.
7498
7499 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7500 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7501 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7502 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7503 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7504 exists.
7505
7506 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7507 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7508 unobvious parameters.
7509
7510 Example :
7511 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7512 backend public_www
7513 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7514 stats enable
7515 stats hide-version
7516 stats scope .
7517 stats uri /admin?stats
7518 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7519 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7520 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7521
7522 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7523 backend private_monitoring
7524 stats enable
7525 stats uri /admin?stats
7526 stats refresh 5s
7527
7528 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7529
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007530
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007531stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007532 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007534 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007535
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007536 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007537 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7538
7539 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7540 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7541
7542 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7543 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007544 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007545
7546 Example :
7547 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7548 backend private_monitoring
7549 stats enable
7550 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7551 stats uri /admin?stats
7552 stats refresh 5s
7553
7554 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7555 global section.
7556
7557
7558stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007559 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7561 yes | yes | yes | yes
7562 Arguments : none
7563
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007564 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007565 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7566 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7567 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7568 - IP (socket, server)
7569 - cookie (backend, server)
7570
7571 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7572 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007573 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007574
7575 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7576
7577
7578stats show-node [ <name> ]
7579 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007581 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007582 Arguments:
7583 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7584 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7585
7586 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7587 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007588 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007589
7590 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7591 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7592 unobvious parameters.
7593
7594 Example:
7595 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7596 backend private_monitoring
7597 stats enable
7598 stats show-node Europe-1
7599 stats uri /admin?stats
7600 stats refresh 5s
7601
7602 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7603 section.
7604
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007605
7606stats uri <prefix>
7607 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007609 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007610 Arguments :
7611 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7612 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7613 query string.
7614
7615 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7616 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7617 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7618 possible to reach it in the application.
7619
7620 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007621 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007622 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7623 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7624 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7625 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7626
7627 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7628 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7629 an address or a port to statistics only.
7630
7631 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7632 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7633 unobvious parameters.
7634
7635 Example :
7636 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7637 backend public_www
7638 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7639 stats enable
7640 stats hide-version
7641 stats scope .
7642 stats uri /admin?stats
7643 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7644 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7645 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7646
7647 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7648 backend private_monitoring
7649 stats enable
7650 stats uri /admin?stats
7651 stats refresh 5s
7652
7653 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7654
7655
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007656stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7657 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007659 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007660
7661 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007662 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007663 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7664 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7665 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7666
7667 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7668 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7669 the "stick-table" statement.
7670
7671 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7672 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7673 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7674 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7675 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7676
7677 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7678 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7679 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7680 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7681 transformation rules.
7682
7683 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7684 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7685 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7686 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7687 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7688 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7689 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7690
7691 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7692 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7693 ACL based conditions.
7694
7695 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7696 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7697 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7698 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7699
7700 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7701 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7702 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7703 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7704
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007705 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7706 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7707 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7708
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007709 Example :
7710 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7711 # last 30 minutes
7712 backend pop
7713 mode tcp
7714 balance roundrobin
7715 stick store-request src
7716 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7717 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7718 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7719
7720 backend smtp
7721 mode tcp
7722 balance roundrobin
7723 stick match src table pop
7724 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7725 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7726
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007727 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007728 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007729
7730
7731stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7732 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7734 no | no | yes | yes
7735
7736 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7737 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7738 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7739 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7740
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007741 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7742 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7743 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7744
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007745 Examples :
7746 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007747 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007748
7749 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7750 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7751 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7752
7753
7754 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7755 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7756 backend http
7757 mode http
7758 balance roundrobin
7759 stick on src table https
7760 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7761 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7762 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7763
7764 backend https
7765 mode tcp
7766 balance roundrobin
7767 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7768 stick on src
7769 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7770 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7771
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007772 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007773
7774
7775stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7776 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7778 no | no | yes | yes
7779
7780 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007781 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007782 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7783 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7784 server is selected.
7785
7786 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7787 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7788 the "stick-table" statement.
7789
7790 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7791 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7792 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7793 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7794 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7795 address.
7796
7797 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7798 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7799 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7800 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7801 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7802 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7803 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7804 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7805 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7806 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7807
7808 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7809 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7810 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7811 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7812 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7813 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7814 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7815
7816 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7817 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7818 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7819 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7820
7821 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7822 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7823 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7824 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7825 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7826 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007827 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7828 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7829 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7830 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7831 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7832 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007833
7834 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7835 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7836 the request.
7837
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007838 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7839 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7840 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7841
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007842 Example :
7843 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7844 # last 30 minutes
7845 backend pop
7846 mode tcp
7847 balance roundrobin
7848 stick store-request src
7849 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7850 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7851 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7852
7853 backend smtp
7854 mode tcp
7855 balance roundrobin
7856 stick match src table pop
7857 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7858 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7859
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007860 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007861 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007862
7863
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007864stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007865 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7866 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007867 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007869 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007870
7871 Arguments :
7872 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7873 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7874 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7875 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7876
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007877 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7878 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7879 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7880 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7881
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007882 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7883 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7884 instance.
7885
7886 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7887 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7888 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7889 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7890 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7891 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007892 to 32 characters.
7893
7894 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7895 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7896 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007897 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007898 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7899 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007900
7901 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007902 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7903 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007904 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7905 increase.
7906
7907 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007908 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7909 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7910 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007911
7912 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7913 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7914 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7915 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7916 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7917 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7918 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7919 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7920 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7921 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7922 parameter (see below).
7923
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007924 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7925 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7926 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7927 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7928 soft restart.
7929
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007930 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7931 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007932
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007933 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7934 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7935 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7936 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7937 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007938 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007939 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7940 if not expiration delay is specified.
7941
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007942 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7943 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7944 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7945 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007946 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7947 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7948 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7949 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7950 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7951 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7952 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7953 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7954 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7955 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7956 types and their arguments.
7957
7958 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7959 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7960 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7961 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7962
7963 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7964 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7965 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7966 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7967
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007968 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7969 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7970 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7971 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7972 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7973 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7974
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007975 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7976 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7977 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7978 they were received.
7979
7980 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7981 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7982 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7983 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7984 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7985
7986 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7987 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7988 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7989 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7990 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7991
7992 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7993 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7994 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7995
7996 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7997 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7998 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7999 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8000 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8001
8002 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8003 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8004 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8005 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8006 the client side.
8007
8008 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8009 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8010 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8011 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8012 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8013 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8014 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8015
8016 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8017 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8018 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8019 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8020 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8021 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8022 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8023
8024 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8025 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8026 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8027 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8028 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8029 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8030
8031 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8032 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8033 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8034 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8035
8036 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8037 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8038 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8039 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8040 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8041 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8042 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8043 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8044 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8045 recommended for better fairness.
8046
8047 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8048 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8049 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8050 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8051
8052 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8053 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8054 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8055 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8056 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8057 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8058 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8059 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8060 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8061 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008062
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008063 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8064 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008065 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8066 reference it.
8067
8068 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8069 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
8070 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
8071 as an exclusive stickiness.
8072
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008073 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8074 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8075 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8076 something that can be ignored.
8077
8078 Example:
8079 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8080 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8081 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8082 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8083
8084 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008085 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008086
8087
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008088stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8089 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 no | no | yes | yes
8092
8093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008094 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008095 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8096 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8097 server is selected.
8098
8099 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8100 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8101 the "stick-table" statement.
8102
8103 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8104 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8105 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8106 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8107
8108 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8109 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8110 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8111 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8112 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8113 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008114 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008115 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8116 rules.
8117
8118 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8119 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8120 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8121 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8122 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8123 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8124 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8125
8126 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8127 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8128 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8129 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8130
8131 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8132 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8133 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8134 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8135 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8136 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008137 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8138 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8139 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8140 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8141 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8142 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8143 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8144 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8145 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008146
8147 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8148
8149 Example :
8150 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8151 backend https
8152 mode tcp
8153 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008154 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008155 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008156
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008157 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8158 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8159
8160 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8161 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8162 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8163
8164 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8165 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008166
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008167 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8168 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8169 # at offset 44.
8170
8171 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8172 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8173
8174 # Learn on response if server hello.
8175 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008176
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008177 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8178 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8179
8180 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8181 extraction.
8182
8183
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008184tcp-check connect [params*]
8185 Opens a new connection
8186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 no | no | yes | yes
8188
8189 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8190 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8191 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8192
8193 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8194 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8195 of the sequence.
8196
8197 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8198 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8199 do.
8200
8201 Parameters :
8202 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8203 use the TCP connection.
8204
8205 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8206 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8207 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8208
8209 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8210
8211 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8212
8213 Examples:
8214 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8215 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8216 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8217 option tcp-check
8218 tcp-check connect
8219 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8220 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8221 tcp-check send \r\n
8222 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8223 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8224 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8225 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8226 tcp-check send \r\n
8227 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8228 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8229
8230 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8231 option tcp-check
8232 tcp-check connect port 110
8233 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8234 tcp-check connect port 143
8235 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8236 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8237
8238 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8239
8240
8241tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8242 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 no | no | yes | yes
8245
8246 Arguments :
8247 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8248 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8249 binary.
8250 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8251 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8252 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8253
8254 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8255 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8256 with the usual backslash ('\').
8257 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8258 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8259 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8260 used upper or lower case.
8261
8262
8263 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8264
8265 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8266 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8267 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8268 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8269 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8270 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8271 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8272 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8273
8274 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8275 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8276 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8277 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8278 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8279 expression.
8280
8281 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8282 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8283 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8284 this exact hexadecimal string.
8285 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8286
8287 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8288 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8289 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8290 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8291 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8292 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8293 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8294 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8295 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8296 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8297 the null character.
8298
8299 Examples :
8300 # perform a POP check
8301 option tcp-check
8302 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8303
8304 # perform an IMAP check
8305 option tcp-check
8306 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8307
8308 # look for the redis master server
8309 option tcp-check
8310 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008311 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008312 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8313 tcp-check expect string role:master
8314 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8315 tcp-check expect string +OK
8316
8317
8318 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8319 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8320
8321
8322tcp-check send <data>
8323 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 no | no | yes | yes
8326
8327 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8328 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8329
8330 Examples :
8331 # look for the redis master server
8332 option tcp-check
8333 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8334 tcp-check expect string role:master
8335
8336 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8337 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8338
8339
8340tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8341 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8342 tcp health check
8343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8344 no | no | yes | yes
8345
8346 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8347 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8348 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8349 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8350 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8351 hexadecimal string.
8352 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8353
8354 Examples :
8355 # redis check in binary
8356 option tcp-check
8357 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8358 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8359
8360
8361 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8362 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8363
8364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008365tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8366 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8368 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008369 Arguments :
8370 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008371 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8372 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008373
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008374 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008375
8376 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8377 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008378 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8379 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8380 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8381 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8382 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8383 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008385 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8386 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8387 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8388 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008389
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008390 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008391 - accept :
8392 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8393 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8394 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008396 - reject :
8397 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8398 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8399 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8400 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8401 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8402 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8403 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8404 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8405 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8406 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8407 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8408 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008409
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008410 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8411 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8412 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8413 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8414 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8415 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8416 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8417 hosts.
8418
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008419 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8420 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8421 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8422 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8423 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8424 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8425 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8426 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8427 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008428 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8429 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008430
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008431 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008432 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008433 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008434 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008435 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8436 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008437 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008438 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8439 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8440 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8441 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8442 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008443
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008444 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008445 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008446 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008447 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8448 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8449 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8450 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008452 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8453 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8454 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8455 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008457 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8458 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8459 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8460 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8461 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008462 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8463 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8464 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8465 layer7 information is extracted.
8466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008467 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8468 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8469 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8470 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8471 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008472
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008473 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8474 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8475 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8476 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8477
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008478 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8479 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8480 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8481 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8482 continues.
8483
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008484 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8485 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8486 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008488 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8489 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8490 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008492 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008493 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008494 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008496 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8497 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8498 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008500 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008501 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8502 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008503
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008504 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8505
8506 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8507
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008508 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8509
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008510 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008511
8512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008513tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8514 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008516 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008517 Arguments :
8518 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008519 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008520 "track-sc2", "sc-inc-gpc0", "sc-set-gpt0", "capture" and "lua".
8521 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008523 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008525 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8526 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8527 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8528 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8529 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008530
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008531 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8532 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8533 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8534 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008535 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8536 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8537 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8538 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8539 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8540 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008541 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008542 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008544 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8545 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8546 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8547 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008548
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008549 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008550 - accept : the request is accepted
8551 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8552 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008553 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008554 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008555 - set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008556 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008557 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008559 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8560 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008561
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008562 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8563 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8564 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8565 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8566 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8567 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008569 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008570 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8571 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008572
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008573 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008574 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8575 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8576 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8577 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008578 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8579 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8580 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008581
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008582 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008583 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8584 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8585 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008586
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008587 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8588 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8589 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8590 documentation.
8591
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008592 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8593 declared inline.
8594
8595 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8596 The allowed scopes are:
8597 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8598 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8599 (request and response)
8600 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8601 processing
8602 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8603 processing.
8604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8605 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8606
8607 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8608 followed by some converters.
8609
8610 Example:
8611
8612 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8613
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008614 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008615 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8616 # and reject everything else.
8617 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8618 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008619 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008620 tcp-request content reject
8621
8622 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008623 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8624 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8625 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008626 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008627
8628 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8629 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8630 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008631 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008632 tcp-request content reject
8633
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008634 Example:
8635 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8636 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008637 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008638
8639 Example:
8640 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8641 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008642 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008643
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008644 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8645 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8646
8647 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008648 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008649 # protecting all our sites
8650 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008651 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8652 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008653 ...
8654 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8655
8656 backend http_dynamic
8657 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008658 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008659 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008660 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8661 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8662 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008663 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008665 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008667 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008668
8669
8670tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8671 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008673 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008674 Arguments :
8675 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8676 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8677 as explained at the top of this document.
8678
8679 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8680 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8681 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8682 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8683 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8684
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008685 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8686 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8687 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8688 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8689
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008690 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8691 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008692 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008693 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008694 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8695 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8696 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8697 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008698
8699 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8700 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8701 it pass through unaffected.
8702
8703 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8704 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8705 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008706 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008707 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8708 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008709 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8710 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8711 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008712
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008713 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008714 "timeout client".
8715
8716
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008717tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8718 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8720 no | no | yes | yes
8721 Arguments :
8722 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008723 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua",
8724 "sc-inc-gpc0" and "sc-set-gpt0".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008725
8726 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8727
8728 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8729 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8730 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008731 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8732 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008733
8734 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8735
8736 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8737 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8738 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8739 inserted.
8740
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008741 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008742 - accept :
8743 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8744 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8745 the rules evaluation.
8746
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008747 - close :
8748 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8749 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8750 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8751 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8752 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8753 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008754 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008755 protocols.
8756
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008757 - reject :
8758 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8759 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008760 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008761
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008762 - lua <function>
8763 Executes Lua.
8764
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008765 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8766 Sets a variable.
8767
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008768 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8769 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8770 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8771 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8772
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008773 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8774 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8775 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8776 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8777 continues.
8778
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008779 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8780 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8781 for changing the default action to a reject.
8782
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008783 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8784 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8785 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8786 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008787 period.
8788
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008789 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8790 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8791 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8792 documentation.
8793
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008794 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8795 declared inline.
8796
8797 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8798 The allowed scopes are:
8799 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8800 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8801 (request and response)
8802 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8803 processing
8804 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8805 processing.
8806 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8807 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8808
8809 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8810 followed by some converters.
8811
8812 Example:
8813
8814 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8815
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008816 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8817
8818 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8819
8820
8821tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8822 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 no | no | yes | yes
8825 Arguments :
8826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8828 as explained at the top of this document.
8829
8830 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8831
8832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008833timeout check <timeout>
8834 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8835 established.
8836
8837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 yes | no | yes | yes
8839 Arguments:
8840 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8841 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8842 as explained at the top of this document.
8843
8844 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8845 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8846 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8847 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008848 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8849 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8850 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008851
8852 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8853 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8854
8855 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8856 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008857 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008858
8859 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8860 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8861 forget about it.
8862
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008863 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8864 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008865
8866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008867timeout client <timeout>
8868timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8869 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 yes | yes | yes | no
8872 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008873 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008874 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8875 as explained at the top of this document.
8876
8877 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8878 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8879 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8880 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8881 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8882 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8883 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8884 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008885 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008886 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008887 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8888 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008889 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8890 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008891
8892 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8893 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8894 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8895 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8896 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8897 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8898
8899 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8900 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8901 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8902
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008903 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008904
8905
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008906timeout client-fin <timeout>
8907 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8909 yes | yes | yes | no
8910 Arguments :
8911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8913 as explained at the top of this document.
8914
8915 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8916 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8917 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8918 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8919 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8920 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8921 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8922 down in one direction.
8923
8924 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8925 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8926 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8927
8928 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8929
8930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008931timeout connect <timeout>
8932timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8933 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8935 yes | no | yes | yes
8936 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8939 as explained at the top of this document.
8940
8941 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008942 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008943 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008944 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008945 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8946 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008947
8948 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8949 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8950 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8951 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8952 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8953 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8954
8955 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8956 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8957 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8958
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008959 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8960 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008961
8962
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008963timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8964 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8966 yes | yes | yes | yes
8967 Arguments :
8968 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8969 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8970 as explained at the top of this document.
8971
8972 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8973 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8974 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8975 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8976 once the request has started to present itself.
8977
8978 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8979 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8980 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8981 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8982 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8983
8984 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8985 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8986 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8987 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8988
8989 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8990 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8991 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8992 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8993 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008994 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008995
8996 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8997 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8998 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8999 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9000
9001 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9002
9003
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009004timeout http-request <timeout>
9005 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009007 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9011 as explained at the top of this document.
9012
9013 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9014 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9015 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9016 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9017 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9018 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9019 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009020 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9021 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9022 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9023 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9024 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009025 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9026 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009027
9028 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
9029 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009030 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
9031 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009032
9033 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9034 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9035 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9036 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9037 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9038
9039 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009040 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9041 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9042 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009043
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009044 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
9045 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009046
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009047
9048timeout queue <timeout>
9049 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9051 yes | no | yes | yes
9052 Arguments :
9053 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9054 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9055 as explained at the top of this document.
9056
9057 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9058 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9059 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9060 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9061 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9062
9063 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9064 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9065 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9066 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9067
9068 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9069
9070
9071timeout server <timeout>
9072timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9073 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9075 yes | no | yes | yes
9076 Arguments :
9077 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9078 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9079 as explained at the top of this document.
9080
9081 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9082 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9083 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9084 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9085 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9086 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9087 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9088
9089 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9090 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9091 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9092 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9093 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009094 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009095 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009096 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9097 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9098 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9099 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009100
9101 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9102 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9103 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9104 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9105 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9106 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9107
9108 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9109 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9110 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9111
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009112 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009113
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009114
9115timeout server-fin <timeout>
9116 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9118 yes | no | yes | yes
9119 Arguments :
9120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9122 as explained at the top of this document.
9123
9124 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9125 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9126 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9127 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9128 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9129 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9130 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9131 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9132 situations, it should not be needed.
9133
9134 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9135 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9136 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9137
9138 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9139
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009140
9141timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009142 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9144 yes | yes | yes | yes
9145 Arguments :
9146 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9147 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9148 as explained at the top of this document.
9149
9150 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9151 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9152 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9153
9154 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9155 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9156 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9157 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009158 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009159
9160 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9161
9162
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009163timeout tunnel <timeout>
9164 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9166 yes | no | yes | yes
9167 Arguments :
9168 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9169 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9170 as explained at the top of this document.
9171
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009172 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009173 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9174 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9175 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9176 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9177 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9178 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9179 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9180 specified.
9181
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009182 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9183 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9184 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9185 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9186 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9187 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9188 state.
9189
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009190 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9191 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9192 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9193 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9194 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9195
9196 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9197 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9198 forget about it.
9199
9200 Example :
9201 defaults http
9202 option http-server-close
9203 timeout connect 5s
9204 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009205 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009206 timeout server 30s
9207 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9208
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009209 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009210
9211
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009212transparent (deprecated)
9213 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009215 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009216 Arguments : none
9217
9218 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9219 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9220 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9221 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9222 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9223 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9224 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9225 appropriate server.
9226
9227 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9228
9229 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9230 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9231
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009232 See also: "option transparent"
9233
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009234unique-id-format <string>
9235 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9237 yes | yes | yes | no
9238 Arguments :
9239 <string> is a log-format string.
9240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009241 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9242 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9243 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9244 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009245
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009246 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9247 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9248 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9249 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9250 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9251 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9252 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9253 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009254
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009255 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9256 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009258 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009259
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009260 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009261
9262 will generate:
9263
9264 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9265
9266 See also: "unique-id-header"
9267
9268unique-id-header <name>
9269 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 yes | yes | yes | no
9272 Arguments :
9273 <name> is the name of the header.
9274
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009275 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9276 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009277
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009278 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009279
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009280 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009281 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9282
9283 will generate:
9284
9285 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9286
9287 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009288
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009289use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009290 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9292 no | yes | yes | no
9293 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009294 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9295 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009296
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009297 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9298 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009299
9300 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9301 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9302 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009303 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9304 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9305 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9306 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009307
9308 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9309 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9310 assign the backend.
9311
9312 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9313 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9314 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9315 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9316 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9317 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9318
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009319 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009320 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009321 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9322 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9323 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9324
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009325 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9326 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9327 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9328 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9329 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9330 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9331 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9332 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9333 cannot be forced from the request.
9334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009335 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009336 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9337 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9338
9339 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9340 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009341
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009342
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009343use-server <server> if <condition>
9344use-server <server> unless <condition>
9345 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9347 no | no | yes | yes
9348 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009349 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009350
9351 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9352
9353 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9354 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9355 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9356
9357 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9358 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9359 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9360 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9361 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9362 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9363 matches will assign the server.
9364
9365 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9366 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9367 with the next rules until one matches.
9368
9369 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9370 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9371 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9372 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9373
9374 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9375 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9376 stripped.
9377
9378 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9379 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9380 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9381 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9382
9383 Example :
9384 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9385 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9386 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9387 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9388 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9389 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9390 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9391 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9392 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9393
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009394 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009396
93975. Bind and Server options
9398--------------------------
9399
9400The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9401depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9402settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9403written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9404described in this section.
9405
9406
94075.1. Bind options
9408-----------------
9409
9410The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9411as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9412no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9413parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9414while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9415provided immediately after the setting name.
9416
9417The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9418
9419accept-proxy
9420 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009421 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9422 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009423 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9424 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9425 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9426 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9427 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9428 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9429 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009430 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9431 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009432
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009433alpn <protocols>
9434 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9435 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9436 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9437 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9438 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9439 initial NPN extension.
9440
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009441backlog <backlog>
9442 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9443 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9444
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009445ecdhe <named curve>
9446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009447 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9448 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009449
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009450ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9452 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9453 client's certificate.
9454
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009455ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9457 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9458 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9459 error is ignored.
9460
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009461ca-sign-file <cafile>
9462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9463 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9464 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9465 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9466 'generate-certificates' for details.
9467
9468ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9470 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9471 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9472 'generate-certificates' for details.
9473
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009474ciphers <ciphers>
9475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9476 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009477 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009478 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9479 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9480
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009481crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9483 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9484 to verify client's certificate.
9485
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009486crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9488 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9489 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9490 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9491 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9492 file.
9493
9494 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9495 are loaded.
9496
9497 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009498 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009499 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9500 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9501 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9502 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9503 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9504 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9505 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009506
9507 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9508 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9509 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9510 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009511 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9512 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009513
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009514 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009515
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009516 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9517 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009518 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009519 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9520 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9521 clients).
9522
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009523 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9524 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9525 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9526 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9527 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9528 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9529 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9530 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9531 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9532 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9533 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9534 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9535 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9536
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009537 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9538 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9539 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9540 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9541 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9542
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009543crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9545 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009546 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009547 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009548
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009549crt-list <file>
9550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009551 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9552 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009553
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009554 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009555
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009556 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9557 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9558 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9559 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9560 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9561 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9562 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9563 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009564
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009565defer-accept
9566 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9567 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9568 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9569 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9570 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9571 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9572 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9573 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9574 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9575 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9576 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9577
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009578force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009579 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009580 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009581 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9582 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009583
9584force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009585 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009586 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9587 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009588
9589force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009590 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009591 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9592 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009593
9594force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009595 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009596 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9597 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009598
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009599generate-certificates
9600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9601 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9602 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9603 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9604 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9605 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9606 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9607 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9608 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9609 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9610 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9611
9612 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9613 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9614 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9615 certificate is used many times.
9616
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009617gid <gid>
9618 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9619 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9620 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9621 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9622 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9623
9624group <group>
9625 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9626 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9627 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9628 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9629 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9630
9631id <id>
9632 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9633 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9634 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9635 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9636
9637interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009638 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9639 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9640 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9641 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9642 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9643 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9644 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009645
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009646level <level>
9647 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9648 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9649 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9650 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9651 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9652 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9653 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9654 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9655 counters).
9656 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9657 all counters).
9658
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009659maxconn <maxconn>
9660 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9661 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9662 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9663 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9664 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9665 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9666 eat all memory.
9667
9668mode <mode>
9669 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9670 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9671 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9672 UNIX sockets.
9673
9674mss <maxseg>
9675 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9676 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9677 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9678 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9679 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9680 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9681 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9682 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9683 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9684 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9685 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9686
9687name <name>
9688 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9689 page.
9690
9691nice <nice>
9692 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9693 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9694 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9695 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9696 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9697 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9698 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9699 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9700 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9701 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9702 one for an RDP socket.
9703
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009704no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009706 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009707 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009708 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9709 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009710 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009711
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009712no-tls-tickets
9713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9714 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9715 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009716 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9717 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009718
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009719no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009721 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009722 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009723 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9724 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9725 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009726
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009727no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009729 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009730 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009731 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9732 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9733 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009734
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009735no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009737 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009738 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009739 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9740 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9741 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009742
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009743npn <protocols>
9744 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9745 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9746 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9747 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009748 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9749 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009750
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009751process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9752 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9753 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9754 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9755 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9756 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9757 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9758 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009759 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9760 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9761 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9762 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9763 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9764 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9765 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009766
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009767ssl
9768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009769 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009770 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9771 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9772 to deciphered contents.
9773
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009774strict-sni
9775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9776 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9777 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9778 See the "crt" option for more information.
9779
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009780tcp-ut <delay>
9781 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9782 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9783 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9784 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9785 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9786 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9787 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9788 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9789 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9790 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9791 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9792
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009793tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009794 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009795 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9796 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9797 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9798 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9799 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9800 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9801 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009802 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9803 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9804 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009805
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009806tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9807 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9808 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9809 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9810 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9811 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9812 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9813 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9814 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9815 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9816 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9817
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009818transparent
9819 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9820 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9821 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9822 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9823 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9824 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9825 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9826 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9827 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9828 so check for support with your vendor.
9829
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009830v4v6
9831 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9832 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9833 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9834 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009835 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009836
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009837v6only
9838 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9839 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9840 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009841 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9842 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009843
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009844uid <uid>
9845 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9846 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9847 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9848 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9849 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9850
9851user <user>
9852 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9853 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9854 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9855 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9856 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9857
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009858verify [none|optional|required]
9859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9860 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9861 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9862 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9863 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009864 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9865 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9866 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9867 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009868
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020098695.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009870------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009872The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9873which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9874arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9875settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9876after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9877Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9878address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009880 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009881 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009883The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009884
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009885addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009886 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9887 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9888 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9889 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9890 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009892 Supported in default-server: No
9893
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009894agent-check
9895 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009896 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9897 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9898 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9899 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009900
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009901 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009902 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009903 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9904 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9905 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009906
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009907 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9908 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009909
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009910 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9911 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9912 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009913
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009914 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9915 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9916 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009917
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009918 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9919 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9920 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9921 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9922 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9923 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9924 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009925
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009926 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9927 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009928
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009929 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9930 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9931 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9932 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9933 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9934 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9935 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9936 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9937 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009938
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009939 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9940 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009941 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9942 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9943 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9944 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009945
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009946 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9947 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009948
9949 Supported in default-server: No
9950
9951agent-inter <delay>
9952 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9953 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9954
9955 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9956 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9957 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9958 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9959 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9960 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9961 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9962 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9963 of backends use the same servers.
9964
9965 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9966
9967 Supported in default-server: Yes
9968
9969agent-port <port>
9970 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9971
9972 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9973
9974 Supported in default-server: Yes
9975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009976backup
9977 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9978 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9979 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9980 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9981 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9982 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009984 Supported in default-server: No
9985
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009986ca-file <cafile>
9987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9988 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9989 server's certificate.
9990
9991 Supported in default-server: No
9992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009993check
9994 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009995 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9996 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9997 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9998 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9999 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10000 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10001 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010002 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10003 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10004 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010006 Supported in default-server: No
10007
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010008check-send-proxy
10009 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10010 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10011 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10012 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10013 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10014 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10015 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10016
10017 Supported in default-server: No
10018
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010019check-ssl
10020 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10021 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10022 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10023 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010024 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010025 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10026 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10027 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10028 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10029
10030 Supported in default-server: No
10031
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010032ciphers <ciphers>
10033 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010034 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010035 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10036 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10037 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10038 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10039 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10040 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10041
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010042 Supported in default-server: No
10043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010044cookie <value>
10045 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10046 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10047 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10048 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10049 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10050 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10051 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010053 Supported in default-server: No
10054
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010055crl-file <crlfile>
10056 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10057 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10058 to verify server's certificate.
10059
10060 Supported in default-server: No
10061
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010062crt <cert>
10063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10064 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10065 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10066 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10067 certificate request.
10068
10069 Supported in default-server: No
10070
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010071disabled
10072 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10073 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10074 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10075 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10076 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10077
10078 Supported in default-server: No
10079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010080error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010081 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10082 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10083 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010085 Supported in default-server: Yes
10086
10087 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010089fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010090 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10091 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10092 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010094 Supported in default-server: Yes
10095
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010096force-sslv3
10097 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10098 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010099 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10100 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010101
10102 Supported in default-server: No
10103
10104force-tlsv10
10105 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010106 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10107 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010108
10109 Supported in default-server: No
10110
10111force-tlsv11
10112 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010113 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10114 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010115
10116 Supported in default-server: No
10117
10118force-tlsv12
10119 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010120 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10121 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010122
10123 Supported in default-server: No
10124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010125id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010126 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10127 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10128 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010130 Supported in default-server: No
10131
10132inter <delay>
10133fastinter <delay>
10134downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010135 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10136 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10137 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10138 between checks depending on the server state :
10139
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010140 Server state | Interval used
10141 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10142 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10143 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10144 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10145 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10146 or yet unchecked. |
10147 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10148 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10149 | "inter" otherwise.
10150 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010152 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10153 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10154 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10155 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010156 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10157 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10158 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10159 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10160 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010162 Supported in default-server: Yes
10163
10164maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010165 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10166 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10167 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10168 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10169 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10170 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10171 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10172 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10173
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010174 Supported in default-server: Yes
10175
10176maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010177 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10178 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10179 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10180 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10181 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10182 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10183 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010185 Supported in default-server: Yes
10186
10187minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010188 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10189 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10190 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10191 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10192 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10193 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010194 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010195 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010197 Supported in default-server: Yes
10198
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010199no-ssl-reuse
10200 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10201 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10202 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10203 and for paranoid users.
10204
10205 Supported in default-server: No
10206
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010207no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010208 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10209 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010210 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010211
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010212 Supported in default-server: No
10213
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010214no-tls-tickets
10215 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10216 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10217 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010218 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10219 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010220
10221 Supported in default-server: No
10222
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010223no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010224 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010225 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10226 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010227 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10228 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10229 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010230
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010231 Supported in default-server: No
10232
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010233no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010234 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010235 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10236 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010237 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10238 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10239 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010240
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010241 Supported in default-server: No
10242
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010243no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010244 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010245 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10246 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010247 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10248 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10249 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010250
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010251 Supported in default-server: No
10252
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010253non-stick
10254 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10255 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10256 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10257
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010258 Supported in default-server: No
10259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010260observe <mode>
10261 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10262 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10263 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10264 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10265 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10266 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010267 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010269 Supported in default-server: No
10270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010271 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010273on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010274 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10275 Currently, four modes are available:
10276 - fastinter: force fastinter
10277 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10278 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10279 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10280 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010282 Supported in default-server: Yes
10283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010284 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10285
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010286on-marked-down <action>
10287 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10288 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010289 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10290 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10291 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10292 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10293 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10294 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10295 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10296 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010297
10298 Actions are disabled by default
10299
10300 Supported in default-server: Yes
10301
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010302on-marked-up <action>
10303 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10304 Currently one action is available:
10305 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10306 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10307 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10308 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10309 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10310 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10311 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10312 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10313
10314 Actions are disabled by default
10315
10316 Supported in default-server: Yes
10317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010318port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010319 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10320 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10321 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10322 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10323 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10324 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010326 Supported in default-server: Yes
10327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010328redir <prefix>
10329 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10330 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10331 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10332 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10333 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10334 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10335 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10336 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010337 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010338 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10339 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10340 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10341 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10342 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10343
10344 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010346 Supported in default-server: No
10347
10348rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010349 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10350 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10351 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010353 Supported in default-server: Yes
10354
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010355resolve-prefer <family>
10356 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10357 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10358 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10359 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10360
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010361 Default value: ipv6
10362
10363 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010364
10365 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10366
10367resolvers <id>
10368 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10369 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010370 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10371 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10372 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10373 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010374
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010375 Supported in default-server: No
10376
10377 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010378
10379 See also chapter 5.3
10380
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010381send-proxy
10382 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10383 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10384 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10385 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10386 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10387 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10388 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10389 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10390 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010391 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10392 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10393 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10394 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10395 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010396
10397 Supported in default-server: No
10398
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010399send-proxy-v2
10400 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10401 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10402 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10403 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10404 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10405 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10406 option of the "bind" keyword.
10407
10408 Supported in default-server: No
10409
10410send-proxy-v2-ssl
10411 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10412 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10413 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10414 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10415 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10416 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10417 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10418 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10419
10420 Supported in default-server: No
10421
10422send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10423 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10424 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10425 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10426 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10427 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10428 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10429 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10430 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10431 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10432
10433 Supported in default-server: No
10434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010435slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010436 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10437 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10438 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10439 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10440 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10441 parameters :
10442
10443 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10444 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10445
10446 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10447 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10448 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10449 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10450
10451 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10452 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10453 seen as failed.
10454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010455 Supported in default-server: Yes
10456
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010457sni <expression>
10458 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10459 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10460 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10461 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10462 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10463
10464 Supported in default-server: no
10465
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010466source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010467source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010468source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010469 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10470 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10471 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10472 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10473
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010474 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10475 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10476 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10477 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10478 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10479 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10480 server.
10481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010482 Supported in default-server: No
10483
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010484ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010485 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10486 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10487 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10488 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10489 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10490 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010491 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010492
10493 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010495track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010496 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10497 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10498 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10499 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010500 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010502 Supported in default-server: No
10503
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010504verify [none|required]
10505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010506 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10507 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10508 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10509 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010510 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10511 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10512 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010513
10514 Supported in default-server: No
10515
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010516verifyhost <hostname>
10517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10518 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10519 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10520 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10521 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10522 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10523
10524 Supported in default-server: No
10525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010526weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010527 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10528 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10529 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010530 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10531 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10532 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10533 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10534 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10535 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010537 Supported in default-server: Yes
10538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010539
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200105405.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10541-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010542
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010543HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10544using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10545configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010546This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10547can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10548workload.
10549This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10550resolution at run time.
10551Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10552carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10553
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010554Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10555health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10556
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010557
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200105585.3.1. Global overview
10559----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010560
10561As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10562different steps of the process life:
10563
10564 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10565 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10566 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10567
10568 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10569 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10570 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10571
10572A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10573 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10574 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10575 resolution to know this new IP.
10576
10577A few things important to notice:
10578 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10579 first valid response.
10580
10581 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10582 servers return an error.
10583
10584
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200105855.3.2. The resolvers section
10586----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010587
10588This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10589HAProxy.
10590There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10591many name servers.
10592
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010593When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10594uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10595is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10596answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10597
10598When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10599used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10600
10601Two types of behavior can be applied:
10602 1. stop DNS resolution
10603 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10604 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10605 1. ANY query type
10606 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10607 server's parameter
10608 3. remaining family type
10609
10610HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10611 - invalid DNS response packet
10612 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10613 - NX domain
10614 - Query refused by server
10615 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10616
10617HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10618 - no Answer records in the response
10619 - DNS response truncated
10620 - Error in DNS response
10621 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10622 - name server timeout
10623
10624For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10625 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10626 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10627 applied;
10628 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10629 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
10630 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
10631 stops resolution.
10632
10633
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010634resolvers <resolvers id>
10635 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10636
10637A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10638
10639nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10640 DNS server description:
10641 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10642 <ip> : IP address of the server
10643 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10644
10645hold <status> <period>
10646 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10647 on last resolution <status>
10648 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10649 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10650 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10651 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10652
10653 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10654
10655 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10656 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10657 the healch check.
10658
10659resolve_retries <nb>
10660 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10661 giving up.
10662 Default value: 3
10663
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010664 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
10665 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
10666 type.
10667
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010668timeout <event> <time>
10669 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10670 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10671 events available are:
10672 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10673 been received.
10674 Default value: 1s
10675 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10676 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10677
10678Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10679
10680 resolvers mydns
10681 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10682 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10683 resolve_retries 3
10684 timeout retry 1s
10685 hold valid 10s
10686
10687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106886. HTTP header manipulation
10689---------------------------
10690
10691In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10692response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10693request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10694which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010695against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010696
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010697If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10698to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10699but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10700HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10701stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10702because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10703a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10704still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010706This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10707in section 4.2 :
10708
10709 - reqadd <string>
10710 - reqallow <search>
10711 - reqiallow <search>
10712 - reqdel <search>
10713 - reqidel <search>
10714 - reqdeny <search>
10715 - reqideny <search>
10716 - reqpass <search>
10717 - reqipass <search>
10718 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10719 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10720 - reqtarpit <search>
10721 - reqitarpit <search>
10722 - rspadd <string>
10723 - rspdel <search>
10724 - rspidel <search>
10725 - rspdeny <search>
10726 - rspideny <search>
10727 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10728 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10729
10730With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10731is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10732parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10733prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10734Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10735
10736 \t for a tab
10737 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10738 \n for a new line (LF)
10739 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10740 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10741 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10742 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10743 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10744
10745The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10746portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10747above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10748regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
107499 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10750is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10751
10752The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10753after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10754
10755Notes related to these keywords :
10756---------------------------------
10757 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10758 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10759 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10760
10761 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10762 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10763 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10764
10765 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10766 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10767 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10768 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10769 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10770
10771 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10772 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10773 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10774 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10775 useless headers before adding new ones.
10776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010777 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010778 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10779
10780 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10781 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10782 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10783
10784 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10785 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010786 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010787
10788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107897. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10790----------------------------------
10791
10792Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10793client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10794The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10795these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10796but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10797data called patterns.
10798
10799
108007.1. ACL basics
10801---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010802
10803The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10804content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10805from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10806simple :
10807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010808 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010809 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010810 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10811 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10814adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010815
10816In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010818 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010819
10820This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10821Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10822and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010823an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10824conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10825as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10826are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010827
10828ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10829'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10830which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10831
10832There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10833performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10836specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10837this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010838methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10839ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840
10841Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10842 - boolean
10843 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10844 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10845 - string
10846 - data block
10847
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010848Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10849converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10850would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10851The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10852which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10853
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010854Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10855keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10856fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10857which are summarized in the table below :
10858
10859 +---------------------+-----------------+
10860 | Sample or converter | Default |
10861 | output type | matching method |
10862 +---------------------+-----------------+
10863 | boolean | bool |
10864 +---------------------+-----------------+
10865 | integer | int |
10866 +---------------------+-----------------+
10867 | ip | ip |
10868 +---------------------+-----------------+
10869 | string | str |
10870 +---------------------+-----------------+
10871 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10872 +---------------------+-----------------+
10873
10874Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10875matching method, see below.
10876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010877The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10878 - boolean
10879 - integer or integer range
10880 - IP address / network
10881 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10882 - regular expression
10883 - hex block
10884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010885The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10886
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010887 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10888 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010889 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010890 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010891 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010892 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010893 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010895The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10896read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10897if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10898lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10899will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10900beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10901a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10902lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10903exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10904
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010905The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10906parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10907ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10908a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10909check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10910
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010911The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10912socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10913file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10916loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10917
10918 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10919
10920In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10921the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10922case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10923as well.
10924
10925The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10926sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10927do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10928methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10929is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10930obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10931followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10932default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10933that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10934string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10935
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010936The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10937By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10938string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10939resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10940server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10941waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10942flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10943function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10946sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10947be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010948
10949 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10950 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10952 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10953 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10954 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010955
10956 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10957 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010958 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010959
10960 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010962
10963 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010964 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010965
10966 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10967 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10968
10969 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10970 binary or string samples.
10971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010972 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10973 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010975 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10976 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10977 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010979 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10980 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010982 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10983 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010985 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10986 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010988 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10989 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010990 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10993 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10994 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010995
10996For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10997request, it is possible to do :
10998
10999 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11000
11001In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11002buffer, one would use the following acl :
11003
11004 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11005
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011006On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11007possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11008
11009 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011011All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11012criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11013method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11014to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11015criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11016the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011019the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11020For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11023 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11024 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11025 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011026
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011027
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011028The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11029types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11030combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11031brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11032default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011034 +-------------------------------------------------+
11035 | Input sample type |
11036 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011037 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11039 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011041 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011043 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011045 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011047 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011049 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011051 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011052 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011053 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011054 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011055 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011057 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011059 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011061 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11063 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11064 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011065
11066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110677.1.1. Matching booleans
11068------------------------
11069
11070In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11071Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11072When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11073that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11074
11075Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11076return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11077"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11078
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110807.1.2. Matching integers
11081------------------------
11082
11083Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11084enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11085to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11086
11087Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11088matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11089lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011090
11091For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11092unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11093representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11094
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011095As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11096two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11097instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11098ranges and operators.
11099
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011100For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011101operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11102Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11103of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011105Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011106
11107 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11108 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11109 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11110 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11111 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11112
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011113For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011114
11115 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11116
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011117This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11118
11119 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111227.1.3. Matching strings
11123-----------------------
11124
11125String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11126different forms :
11127
11128 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11129 patterns ;
11130
11131 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11132 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11133
11134 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11135 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11136
11137 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11138 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11139
11140 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11141 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11142 matches.
11143
11144 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11145 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11146 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011147
11148String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11149exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11150characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11151string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11152to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011153before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011154
11155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111567.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11157---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011158
11159Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11160they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11161possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11162passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11163the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011164the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11165match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011166
11167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11169-------------------------------------
11170
11171It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11172not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11173a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11174to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11175digits may be used upper or lower case.
11176
11177Example :
11178 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11179 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11180
11181
111827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11183---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011184
11185IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11186netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11187within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011188host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011189difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11190at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11191does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11192parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011193
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011194IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11195Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11196trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11197IPv6 patterns.
11198
11199HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11200following situations :
11201 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11202 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11203 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11204 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11205 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11206 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11207 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11208 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11209 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11210 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212
112137.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11214----------------------------------
11215
11216Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11217combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11218
11219 - AND (implicit)
11220 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11221 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011223A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011225 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11228indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11231"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11232requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11233is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11234
11235 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11236 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11237 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11238 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11239
11240To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11241and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11242
11243 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11244 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11245 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11246 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11247
11248 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11249 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11250 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11251 use_backend www if host_www
11252
11253It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11254expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11255be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11256the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11257
11258 The following rule :
11259
11260 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11261 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11262
11263 Can also be written that way :
11264
11265 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11266
11267It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11268to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11269simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11270sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11271good use is the following :
11272
11273 With named ACLs :
11274
11275 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11276 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11277 monitor fail if site_dead
11278
11279 With anonymous ACLs :
11280
11281 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11282
11283See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11284
11285
112867.3. Fetching samples
11287---------------------
11288
11289Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11290against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11291sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11292ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11293of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11294available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11295
11296This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11297Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11298compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11299deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11300
11301The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11302matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11303method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11304indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11305
11306As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11307when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11308mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11309the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11310ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11311
11312Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11313multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11314when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11315incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11316are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11317is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11318all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11319
11320Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11321 - name
11322 - name(arg1)
11323 - name(arg1,arg2)
11324
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011325
113267.3.1. Converters
11327-----------------
11328
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011329Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11330of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11331is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11332was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11333has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11334unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11335
11336These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11337sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11338the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11339support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011340
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011341A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11342support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11343supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11344(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11345bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011348
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011349add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011350 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011351 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11352 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11353 allowed scopes are:
11354 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11355 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11356 response),
11357 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11358 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11359 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11360 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011361
11362and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011363 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011364 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11365 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11366 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11367 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11368 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11369 response),
11370 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11371 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011374
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011375base64
11376 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11377 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11378 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11379
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011380bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011381 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011382 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11383 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11384 presence of a flag).
11385
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011386bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11387 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11388 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11389 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11390
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011391cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011392 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11393 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011394
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011395crc32([<avalanche>])
11396 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11397 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11398 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11399 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11400 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11401 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11402 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11403 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11404 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11405 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11406 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11407
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011408da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11409 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11410 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11411 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11412 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11413 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11414 configuration language.
11415
11416 Example:
11417 frontend www
11418 bind *:8881
11419 default_backend servers
11420 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11421
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011422debug
11423 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11424 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11425 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11426
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011427div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011428 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11429 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011430 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11431 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11432 scope. The scope allowed are:
11433 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11434 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11435 response),
11436 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11437 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11438 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11439 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011440
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011441djb2([<avalanche>])
11442 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11443 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11444 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11445 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11446 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11447 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11448 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011449 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11450 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011451
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011452even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011453 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011454 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11455
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011456field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11457 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11458 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11459 list of chars.
11460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011461hex
11462 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11463 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11464 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11465 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011467http_date([<offset>])
11468 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11469 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11470 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11471 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11472 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11473 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011475in_table(<table>)
11476 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11477 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11478 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11479 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11480 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11481
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011482ipmask(<mask>)
11483 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11484 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11485 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11486 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11487
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011488json([<input-code>])
11489 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11490 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11491 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11492 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11493 of errors:
11494 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11495 bytes, ...)
11496 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11497 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11498
11499 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11500 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11501 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11502 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11503 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11504 are :
11505 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11506 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11507 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11508 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11509 error ;
11510 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11511 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11512
11513 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11514 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11515
11516 Example:
11517 capture request header user-agent len 150
11518 capture request header Host len 15
11519 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11520
11521 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11522 GET / HTTP/1.0
11523 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11524
11525 Output log:
11526 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11527
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011528language(<value>[,<default>])
11529 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11530 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11531 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11532 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11533 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11534 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11535 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11536 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11537 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11538 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11539 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11540 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011541
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011542 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011543
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011544 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11545 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011546
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011547 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11548 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11549 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11550 use_backend spanish if es
11551 use_backend french if fr
11552 use_backend english if en
11553 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011554
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011555lower
11556 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11557 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11558 type. The result is of type string.
11559
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011560ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11561 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11562 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11563 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11564 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11565 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11566 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11567
11568 Example :
11569
11570 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11571 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11572 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011574map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11575map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11576map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11577 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11578 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11579 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11580 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11581 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11582 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11583 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11584 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011585
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011586 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11587 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11588 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011590 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11591 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011593 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11594 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11595 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11596 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011597 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11598 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011599 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11601 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11602 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11603 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11605 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11607 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11609 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11611 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011614 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11615 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11616 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11617 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11618 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011619
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011620 Example :
11621
11622 # this is a comment and is ignored
11623 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11624 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11625 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11626 | | | `---------- value
11627 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11628 | `---------------------------- key
11629 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011631mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011632 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11633 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011634 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11635 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11636 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11637 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11638 response),
11639 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11640 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11641 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11642 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011643
11644mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011645 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011646 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11647 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011648 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11649 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11650 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11651 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11652 response),
11653 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11654 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11656 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011657
11658neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011659 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11660 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11661 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11662 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011663
11664not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011665 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011666 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11667 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11668 absence of a flag).
11669
11670odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011671 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011672 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11673
11674or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011675 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011676 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11677 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11678 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11679 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11680 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11681 response),
11682 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11683 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011686
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011687regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011688 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11689 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11690 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11691 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11692 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11693 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11694 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11695 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11696 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11697 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11698 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11699 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11700 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11701
11702 Example :
11703
11704 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11705 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11706 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11707 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11708
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011709capture-req(<id>)
11710 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11711 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11712
11713 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11714 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11715 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11716
11717capture-res(<id>)
11718 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11719 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11720
11721 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11722 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11723 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11724
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011725sdbm([<avalanche>])
11726 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11727 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11728 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11729 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11730 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11731 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11732 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011733 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11734 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011735
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011736set-var(<var name>)
11737 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11738 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11739 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11740 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11741 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11742 response),
11743 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11744 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11746 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11747
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011748sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011749 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
11750 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011751 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
11752 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11753 scope. The allowed scopes are:
11754 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11755 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11756 response),
11757 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11758 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11759 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11760 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011761
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011762table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11765 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11766 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11767 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11768 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11769
11770
11771table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11775 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11776 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11777 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11778
11779table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11782 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11783 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11784 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11785
11786table_conn_cur(<table>)
11787 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11788 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11789 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11790 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11791 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11792
11793table_conn_rate(<table>)
11794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11796 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11797 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11798 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11799
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011800table_gpt0(<table>)
11801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
11803 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11804 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11805 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
11806
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011807table_gpc0(<table>)
11808 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11809 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11810 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11811 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11812 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11813
11814table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11817 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11818 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11819 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11820 sample fetch keyword.
11821
11822table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11826 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11827 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11828
11829table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11830 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11831 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11832 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11833 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11834 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11835 keyword.
11836
11837table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11838 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11839 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11840 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11841 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11842 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11843
11844table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11847 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11848 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11849 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11850 keyword.
11851
11852table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11853 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11854 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11855 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11856 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11857 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11858 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11859 keyword.
11860
11861table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11865 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11866 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11867 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11868 keyword.
11869
11870table_server_id(<table>)
11871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11874 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11875 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11876 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11877
11878table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11879 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11880 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11881 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11882 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11883 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11884 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11885 keyword.
11886
11887table_sess_rate(<table>)
11888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11891 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11892 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11893 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11894 keyword.
11895
11896table_trackers(<table>)
11897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11900 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11901 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11902 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11903 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11904 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11905 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11906 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11907
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011908upper
11909 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11910 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11911 type. The result is of type string.
11912
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011913url_dec
11914 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11915 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11916
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011917utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11918 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11919 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11920 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11921 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11922 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11923 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11924
11925 Example :
11926
11927 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11928 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11929 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11930
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011931word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11932 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11933 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11934
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011935wt6([<avalanche>])
11936 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11937 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11938 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11939 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11940 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11941 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11942 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011943 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11944 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011945
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011946xor(<value>)
11947 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011948 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011949 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11950 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11951 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11952 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11953 response),
11954 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11955 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11956 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11957 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011958
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200119607.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961--------------------------------------------
11962
11963A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11964not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11965"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11966The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11967
11968always_false : boolean
11969 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11970 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11971
11972always_true : boolean
11973 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11974 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11975
11976avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011977 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11979 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11980 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11981 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11982 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11983 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11984 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11985 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11986 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11987 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11988 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11989 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11990 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011993 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11994 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11995 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11996 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11997 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12000 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12001 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12002 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12003 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12004 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12005 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012006
12007 Example :
12008 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12009 backend dynamic
12010 mode http
12011 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12012 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012013
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012014bin(<hexa>) : bin
12015 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12016 of the string.
12017
12018bool(<bool>) : bool
12019 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12020 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012024 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12026 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012027
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012028 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012029 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012030 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12031
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012032 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12033 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012034
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012035 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012036 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012037 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012038 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12039 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012041 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012042
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012043 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12044 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012045 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012046 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012047
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012048date([<offset>]) : integer
12049 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12050 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12051 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12052 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012053 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12054
12055 Example :
12056
12057 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12058 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012059
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012060env(<name>) : string
12061 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12062 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12063 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12064 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12065 certain way.
12066
12067 Examples :
12068 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12069 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12070
12071 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12072 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012074fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12075 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012076 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12077 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012078 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12079 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12080 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12081 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12082 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012084fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12085 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12086 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12087 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12088 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12089 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12090 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12091 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12092 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012093
12094 Example :
12095 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12096 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12097 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12098 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12099 frontend mail
12100 bind :25
12101 mode tcp
12102 maxconn 100
12103 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12104 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12105 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12106 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012107
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012108int(<integer>) : signed integer
12109 Returns a signed integer.
12110
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012111ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12112 Returns an ipv4.
12113
12114ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12115 Returns an ipv6.
12116
12117meth(<method>) : method
12118 Returns a method.
12119
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012120nbproc : integer
12121 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12122 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12123 and debugging purposes.
12124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12126 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12127 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12128 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012129 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12130 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12131 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012132
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012133proc : integer
12134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12135 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12136 debugging purposes.
12137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012138queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012139 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12140 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12141 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012142 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12143 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12144 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12145 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12146 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12147
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012148rand([<range>]) : integer
12149 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12150 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12151 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12152 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12153 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012155srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12156 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12157 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12158 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12159 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12160 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12161 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12162 methods.
12163
12164srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12165 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12166 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12167 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12168 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12169 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12170 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12171 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12172
12173srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12174 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12175 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012176 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12178 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12179 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12180 overloading servers).
12181
12182 Example :
12183 # Redirect to a separate back
12184 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12185 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12186 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12187
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012188stopping : boolean
12189 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12190 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12191 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12192
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012193str(<string>) : string
12194 Returns a string.
12195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012196table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12197 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12198 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12199
12200table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12201 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12202 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12203 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12204
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012205var(<var-name>) : undefined
12206 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
12207 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
12208 scope. The scope allowed are:
12209 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12210 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12211 response),
12212 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12213 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12214 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12215 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122187.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012219----------------------------------
12220
12221The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12222closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12223methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12224sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12225TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012226the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12227counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12228"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012229argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12230the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12231this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012232
12233be_id : integer
12234 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12235 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12236
12237dst : ip
12238 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12239 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12240 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12241 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12242 RFC 4291.
12243
12244dst_conn : integer
12245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12246 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12247 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12248 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12249 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12250 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12251 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12252 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012254dst_port : integer
12255 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12256 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12257 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12258 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12259 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12260 an HTTP header.
12261
12262fe_id : integer
12263 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12264 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12265 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12266
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012267sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012268sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12269sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12270sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012271 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12272 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12273 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012275sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012276sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12277sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12278sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12280 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12281 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12282
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012283sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012284sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12285sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12286sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012287 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12288 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012289 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12290 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12291 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012292
12293 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12294 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012295 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12296 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12297 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012298 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12299 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12300
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012301sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012302sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12303sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12304sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012305 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12306 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12307
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012308sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012309sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12310sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12311sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012312 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12313 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12314 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12315
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012316sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012317sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12318sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12319sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012320 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12321 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12322 See also src_conn_rate.
12323
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012324sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012325sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12326sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12327sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012328 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012329 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012330
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012331sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12332sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12333sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12334sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12335 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12336 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012338sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012339sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12340sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12341sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012342 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12343 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12344 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012345 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12346 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12347 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012348
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012349sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012350sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12351sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12352sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012353 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12354 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12355 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12356
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012357sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012358sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12359sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12360sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012361 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12362 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12363 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12364 src_http_err_rate.
12365
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012366sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012367sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12368sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12369sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012370 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12371 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12372 src_http_req_cnt.
12373
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012374sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012375sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12376sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12377sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012378 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12379 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12380 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12381 src_http_req_rate.
12382
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012383sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012384sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12385sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12386sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012387 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012388 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12389 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12390 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12391 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012392
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012393 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12394 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012395 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012397sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012398sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12399sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12400sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012401 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12402 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12403 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012404
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012405sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012406sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12407sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12408sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012409 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12410 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12411 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012413sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012414sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12415sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12416sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012417 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12418 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12419 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12420 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012421 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012422 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12423
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012424sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012425sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12426sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12427sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012428 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12429 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12430 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12431 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12432 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012433 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012435sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012436sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12437sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12438sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012439 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12440 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12441 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12442
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012443sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012444sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12445sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12446sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012447 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12448 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012449 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012450 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12451 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12453 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12454 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012456so_id : integer
12457 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12458 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12459 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461src : ip
12462 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12463 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12464 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12465 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12466 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12467 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12468 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012469
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012470 Example:
12471 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12472 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012474src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12475 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12476 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12477 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012478 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12481 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12482 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012483 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012484 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012486src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12487 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12488 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12489 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12490 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12491 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12492 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012493
12494 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12495 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12496 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12497 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012498 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012499 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12500 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012502src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012503 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012504 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012505 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012506 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012508src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012509 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012510 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12511 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012512 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12515 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12516 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12517 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012518 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012520src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012521 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012522 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012523 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012524 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012525
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012526src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12527 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12528 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12529 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12530 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012532src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012533 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012534 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012535 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12536 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012537 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12538 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12539 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012541src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12542 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12543 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012544 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012545 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012546 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12549 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12550 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12551 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12552 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012553 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012555src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12556 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12557 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12558 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012559 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012561src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12562 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12563 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12564 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012565 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012566 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012568src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12569 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12570 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12571 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012572 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012573 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12574 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012575
12576 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012577 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012578 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012581 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12582 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12583 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12584 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12585 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012588 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12589 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12590 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12591 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12592 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012594src_port : integer
12595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12596 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12597 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12598 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012600src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12601 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012602 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12603 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12604 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012605 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12608 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12609 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12610 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12611 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012612 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012614src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12615 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12616 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12617 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12618 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12619 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12620 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12621 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12622 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012623
12624 Example :
12625 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12626 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12627 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12628 listen ssh
12629 bind :22
12630 mode tcp
12631 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012632 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012633 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012634 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012636srv_id : integer
12637 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12638 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12639 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012640
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012641
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126427.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012645The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12646closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12647when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12648usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012649future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012650
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012651ssl_bc : boolean
12652 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12653 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12654 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12655
12656ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12657 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12658 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12659
12660ssl_bc_cipher : string
12661 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12662 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12663
12664ssl_bc_protocol : string
12665 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12666 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12667
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012668ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012669 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012670 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12671 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012672
12673ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12674 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12675 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12676 if session was reused or not.
12677
12678ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12679 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12680 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12683 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12684 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12685 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12686 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12687 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012689ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12690 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12691 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12692 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12693 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012694
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012695ssl_c_der : binary
12696 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12697 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12698 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700ssl_c_err : integer
12701 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12702 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12703 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12704 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12705 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012707ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12708 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12709 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12710 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12711 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12712 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12713 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12714 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12715 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717ssl_c_key_alg : string
12718 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12719 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12720 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722ssl_c_notafter : string
12723 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12724 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12725 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012727ssl_c_notbefore : string
12728 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12729 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12730 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12733 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12734 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12735 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12736 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12737 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12738 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12739 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12740 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742ssl_c_serial : binary
12743 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12744 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12745 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12748 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12749 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12750 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012751 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12752 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12753
12754 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12757 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12758 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12759 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012761ssl_c_used : boolean
12762 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12763 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012765ssl_c_verify : integer
12766 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12767 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12768 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12769 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012771ssl_c_version : integer
12772 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12773 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012774
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012775ssl_f_der : binary
12776 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12777 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12778 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12781 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12782 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12783 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12784 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012785 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12787 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12788 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790ssl_f_key_alg : string
12791 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12792 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12793 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795ssl_f_notafter : string
12796 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12797 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12798 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012800ssl_f_notbefore : string
12801 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12802 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12803 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12807 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12808 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12812 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12813 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815ssl_f_serial : binary
12816 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12817 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12818 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012819
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012820ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12821 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12822 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12823 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12826 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12827 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12828 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830ssl_f_version : integer
12831 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12832 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12833
12834ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012835 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12836 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12837 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 Example :
12840 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12841 listen http-https
12842 bind :80
12843 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12844 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12845
12846ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12847 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12848 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12849
12850ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012851 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12853 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12854 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12855 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12856 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12857 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12858 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12859 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861ssl_fc_cipher : string
12862 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12863 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012866 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12867 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012868 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12869 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12870 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12871 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012873ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12874 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012875 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12876 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12877 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12878 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012879
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012880ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12881 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12882 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012885 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012886 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12887 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12888 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12889 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12890 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12891 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12892 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894ssl_fc_protocol : string
12895 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12896 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012897
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012898ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012899 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012900 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12901 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012903ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12904 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12905 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12906 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12907 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012909ssl_fc_sni : string
12910 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12911 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12912 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12913 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12914 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12915
12916 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12917 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12918 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012919 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12920 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12924 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12927 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12928 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012929
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129317.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012932------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012934Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12935sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12936only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12937For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12938be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12939can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12940sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12941for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12942content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012944payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12945 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12946 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12947 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12950 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12951 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12952 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012954req.len : integer
12955req_len : integer (deprecated)
12956 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12957 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12958 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12959 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12960 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12961 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12962 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12963 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12966 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012967 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12968 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12969 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12970 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972 ACL alternatives :
12973 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12976 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12977 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12978 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12979 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012981 ACL alternatives :
12982 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986req.proto_http : boolean
12987req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12988 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12989 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12990 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12991 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12992 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12993 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12994 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996 Example:
12997 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12998 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12999 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013000 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13003rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13004 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13005 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13006 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13007 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13008 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13009 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13010 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013012 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13013 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13014 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13015 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13016 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13017 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013019 ACL derivatives :
13020 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022 Example :
13023 listen tse-farm
13024 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13025 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13026 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13027 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13028 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13029 persist rdp-cookie
13030 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13031 # This is only useful makes sense if
13032 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13033 stick-table type string size 204800
13034 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13035 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13036 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13039 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13042rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13043 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13044 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13045 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13046 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013048 ACL derivatives :
13049 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013050
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013051req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13052 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13053 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
13054 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC certificate
13055 and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that this only
13056 applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to contents
13057 deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines
13058 having the "ssl" option.
13059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13061req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13062 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13063 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13064 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13065 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13066 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13067 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13068 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070req.ssl_sni : string
13071req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13072 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13073 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13074 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13075 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13076 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13077 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13078 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13079 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13080 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13081 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13082 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13083 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085 ACL derivatives :
13086 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088 Examples :
13089 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13090 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13091 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13092 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13093 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13096rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13097 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13098 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13099 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13100 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13101 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13102 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13103 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020013104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105req.ssl_ver : integer
13106req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13107 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13108 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13109 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13110 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13111 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13112 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13113 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13114 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13115 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 ACL derivatives :
13118 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013119
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013120res.len : integer
13121 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13122 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13123 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13124 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13125 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13126 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13127 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13128 content inspection.
13129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013130res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13131 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013132 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13133 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13134 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13135 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013137res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13138 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13139 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13140 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13141 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013143 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145wait_end : boolean
13146 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13147 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13148 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13149 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13150 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13151 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13152 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13153 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155 Examples :
13156 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13157 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13158 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13161 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13162 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13163 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13164 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13165 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13166 tcp-request content reject
13167
13168
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131697.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170--------------------------------------
13171
13172It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13173This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13174data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13175its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13176HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13177content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13178to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13179more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13180response are indexed.
13181
13182base : string
13183 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13184 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13185 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13186 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13187 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13188 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13189 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13190 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13191
13192 ACL derivatives :
13193 base : exact string match
13194 base_beg : prefix match
13195 base_dir : subdir match
13196 base_dom : domain match
13197 base_end : suffix match
13198 base_len : length match
13199 base_reg : regex match
13200 base_sub : substring match
13201
13202base32 : integer
13203 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13204 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13205 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013206 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13207 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13208 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013209
13210base32+src : binary
13211 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13212 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13213 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13214 per-URL counters.
13215
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013216capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13217 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13218 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13219 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13220
13221capture.req.method : string
13222 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13223 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13224 because it's allocated.
13225
13226capture.req.uri : string
13227 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13228 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13229 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13230 allocated.
13231
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013232capture.req.ver : string
13233 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13234 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13235 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13236
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013237capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13238 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13239 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13240 The first entry is an index of 0.
13241 See also: "capture response header"
13242
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013243capture.res.ver : string
13244 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13245 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13246 persistent flag.
13247
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013248req.body : binary
13249 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13250 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13251 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13252 the first chunk is analyzed.
13253
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013254req.body_param([<name>) : string
13255 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13256 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13257 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13258 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13259 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13260 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13261 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13262 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13263 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13264 given.
13265
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013266req.body_len : integer
13267 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13268 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13269 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13270 "option http-buffer-request".
13271
13272req.body_size : integer
13273 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13274 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13275 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13276 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13277 "option http-buffer-request".
13278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279req.cook([<name>]) : string
13280cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13281 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13282 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13283 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13284 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13285 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13286 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13287 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13288 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13289
13290 ACL derivatives :
13291 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13292 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13293 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13294 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13295 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13296 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13297 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13298 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013300req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13301cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13302 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13303 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013305req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13306cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13308 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13309 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13310 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013312cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13313 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13314 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13315 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13316 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013317 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13319 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13320 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13321 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13324 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13325 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13326 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13327 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013328 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13331 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13332 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13333 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13334 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13335 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13336 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13337 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13338 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13341 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13342 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13343 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13344 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13347 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13348 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13349 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13350 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13351 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13352 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13353 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13354 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13355 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13356 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13357 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359 ACL derivatives :
13360 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13361 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13362 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13363 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13364 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13365 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13366 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13367 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13368
13369req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13370hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13372 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13373 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13374 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13375 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13376 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13377 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13378 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13379 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13380
13381req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13382hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13383 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13384 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13385 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13386 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13387 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13388 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13389 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13390 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13391
13392req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13393hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13394 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13395 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13396 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13397 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13398 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13399 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13400 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13401
13402http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13403 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13404 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13405 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13406 basic auth is supported.
13407
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013408http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13409 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13410 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13411 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13412 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13414 basic auth is supported.
13415
13416 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013417 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13418 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13419 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13420 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013421
13422http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013423 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13424 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13426 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428method : integer + string
13429 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13430 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13431 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13432 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13433 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13434 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13435 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 ACL derivatives :
13438 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440 Example :
13441 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13442 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13443 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445path : string
13446 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13447 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13448 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13449 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13450 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13451 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13452 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454 ACL derivatives :
13455 path : exact string match
13456 path_beg : prefix match
13457 path_dir : subdir match
13458 path_dom : domain match
13459 path_end : suffix match
13460 path_len : length match
13461 path_reg : regex match
13462 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013463
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013464query : string
13465 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13466 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13467 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13468 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13469 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13470 which stops before the question mark.
13471
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013472req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13473 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13474 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13475 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13476 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013478req.ver : string
13479req_ver : string (deprecated)
13480 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13481 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13482 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484 ACL derivatives :
13485 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487res.comp : boolean
13488 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13489 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13490 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013492res.comp_algo : string
13493 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13494 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13495 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497res.cook([<name>]) : string
13498scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13499 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13500 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13501 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013503 ACL derivatives :
13504 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013506res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13507scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13508 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13509 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13510 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013512res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13513scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13514 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13515 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13516 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13519 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13520 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13521 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13522 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13523 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13524 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13525 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13526 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13527 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13530 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13531 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13532 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13533 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13534 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013536res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13537shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13538 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13539 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13540 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13541 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13542 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13543 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13544 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13545 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547 ACL derivatives :
13548 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13549 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13550 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13551 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13552 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13553 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13554 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13555 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13556
13557res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13558shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13559 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13560 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13561 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13562 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13563 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013565res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13566shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13567 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13568 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13569 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13570 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13571 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13572 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013573
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013574res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13575 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13576 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13577 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13578 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013580res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13581shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13582 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13583 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13584 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13585 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13586 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13587 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589res.ver : string
13590resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13591 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13592 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594 ACL derivatives :
13595 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013597set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13598 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13599 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013600 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013601 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13604 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013606status : integer
13607 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13608 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13609 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013611url : string
13612 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13613 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13614 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13615 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13616 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13617 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13618 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013620 ACL derivatives :
13621 url : exact string match
13622 url_beg : prefix match
13623 url_dir : subdir match
13624 url_dom : domain match
13625 url_end : suffix match
13626 url_len : length match
13627 url_reg : regex match
13628 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630url_ip : ip
13631 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13632 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13633 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13634 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13635 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13636 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13637 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639url_port : integer
13640 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13641 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13642 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13643 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013644
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013645urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13646url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13648 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013649 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13650 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13651 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13652 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013653 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13654 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013655 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13656 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013658 ACL derivatives :
13659 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13660 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13661 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13662 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13663 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13664 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13665 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13666 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013667
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013669 Example :
13670 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13671 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13672 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13673 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013674
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013675urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13677 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13678 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013679
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136817.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013682---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013684Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13685every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013686order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013688ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13689---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013690FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013691HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013692HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13693HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013694HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13695HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13696HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13697HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13698LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013699METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13700METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13701METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13702METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13703METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13704METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013705RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013706REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013707TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013708WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13709---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013710
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137128. Logging
13713----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013714
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013715One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13716provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13717very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13718provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13719state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013720to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013721headers.
13722
13723In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13724about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13725send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13726
13727 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13728 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13729 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13730 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13731 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013732 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13733 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013734
13735The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13736allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13737as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13738while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13739real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13740delay.
13741
13742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137438.1. Log levels
13744---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013745
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013746TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013747source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013748HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13749in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13750track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13751syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13752about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013753
13754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137558.2. Log formats
13756----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013757
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013758HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013759and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13760slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13761options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013762
13763 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13764 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13765 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13766 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13767 extents.
13768
13769 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13770 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13771 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13772 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13773 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13774
13775 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13776 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13777 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13778 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13779 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13780
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013781 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13782 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13783 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13784 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13785
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013786 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13787
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013788Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13789specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13790field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13791servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13792always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13793identifier.
13794
13795Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13796 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13797 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13798 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13799 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13800
13801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138028.2.1. Default log format
13803-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013804
13805This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13806as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13807format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13808
13809 Example :
13810 listen www
13811 mode http
13812 log global
13813 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13814
13815 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13816 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13817 (www/HTTP)
13818
13819 Field Format Extract from the example above
13820 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13821 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13822 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13823 4 'to' to
13824 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13825 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13826
13827Detailed fields description :
13828 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13829 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13830 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13831 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13832 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13833 and processed the connection.
13834 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13835
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013836In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13837"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13838connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13839
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013840It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13841will eventually disappear.
13842
13843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138448.2.2. TCP log format
13845---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013846
13847The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13848is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13849information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13850counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13851emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13852environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13853the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13854sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013855specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13856not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13857fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13858marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013859
13860 Example :
13861 frontend fnt
13862 mode tcp
13863 option tcplog
13864 log global
13865 default_backend bck
13866
13867 backend bck
13868 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13869
13870 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13871 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13872 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13873
13874 Field Format Extract from the example above
13875 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13876 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13877 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13878 4 frontend_name fnt
13879 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13880 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13881 7 bytes_read* 212
13882 8 termination_state --
13883 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13884 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13885
13886Detailed fields description :
13887 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013888 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13889 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13890 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13891 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13892 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013893
13894 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013895 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13896 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13897 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013898
13899 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13900 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13901 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13902 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13903
13904 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13905 and processed the connection.
13906
13907 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13908 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13909 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13910 applications.
13911
13912 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13913 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13914 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13915 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13916 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13917
13918 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13919 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13920 See "Timers" below for more details.
13921
13922 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13923 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13924 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13925 "Timers" below for more details.
13926
13927 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013928 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013929 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13930 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13931 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13932 details.
13933
13934 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13935 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13936 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13937 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13938 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13939
13940 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13941 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13942 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13943 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13944 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13945 for more details.
13946
13947 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013948 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013949 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13950 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13951 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013952 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013953
13954 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13955 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13956 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13957 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13958 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13959 caused by a denial of service attack.
13960
13961 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13962 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13963 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13964 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13965 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13966 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13967 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13968 denial of service attack.
13969
13970 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13971 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13972 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13973 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13974 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13975 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13976 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13977 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13978 be processed than on other servers.
13979
13980 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13981 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13982 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13983 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13984 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13985 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13986 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13987 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13988 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13989 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13990 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13991 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13992 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13993
13994 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13995 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13996 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13997 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13998 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13999 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14000 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14001 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14002
14003 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14004 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14005 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14006 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14007 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14008 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14009 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14010 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14011 occurs.
14012
14013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140148.2.3. HTTP log format
14015----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014016
14017The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14018is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14019the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14020are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14021emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14022generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14023"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14024which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014025frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14026is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014027
14028Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14029slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14030with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14031
14032 Example :
14033 frontend http-in
14034 mode http
14035 option httplog
14036 log global
14037 default_backend bck
14038
14039 backend static
14040 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14041
14042 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14043 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14044 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014045 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014046
14047 Field Format Extract from the example above
14048 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14049 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14050 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14051 4 frontend_name http-in
14052 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14053 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14054 7 status_code 200
14055 8 bytes_read* 2750
14056 9 captured_request_cookie -
14057 10 captured_response_cookie -
14058 11 termination_state ----
14059 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14060 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14061 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14062 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14063 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014065
14066Detailed fields description :
14067 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014068 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14069 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14070 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14071 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14072 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014073
14074 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014075 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14076 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14077 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014078
14079 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14080 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14081 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14082 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14083 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14084
14085 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14086 and processed the connection.
14087
14088 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14089 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14090 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14091
14092 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14093 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14094 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14095 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14096 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14097 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14098
14099 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14100 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14101 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14102 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14103 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14104 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14105
14106 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14107 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14108 See "Timers" below for more details.
14109
14110 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14111 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14112 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14113 below for more details.
14114
14115 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14116 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14117 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14118 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14119 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14120 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14121 for more details.
14122
14123 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014124 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014125 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14126 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14127 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14128 details.
14129
14130 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14131 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14132 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14133
14134 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14135 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14136 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14137 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14138 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14139 overflowing.
14140
14141 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14142 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14143 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14144 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14145 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14146 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14147 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14148 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14149
14150 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14151 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14152 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14153 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14154 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14155 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14156 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14157 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14158
14159 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14160 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14161 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14162 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14163 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14164 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14165 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14166
14167 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014168 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014169 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14170 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14171 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014172 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014173 system.
14174
14175 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14176 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14177 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14178 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14179 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14180 caused by a denial of service attack.
14181
14182 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14183 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14184 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14185 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14186 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14187 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14188 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14189 denial of service attack.
14190
14191 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14192 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14193 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14194 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14195 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14196 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14197 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14198 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14199 processed than on other servers.
14200
14201 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14202 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14203 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14204 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14205 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14206 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14207 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14208 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14209 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14210 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14211 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14212 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14213 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14214
14215 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14216 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14217 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14218 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14219 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14220 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14221 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14222 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14223
14224 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14225 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14226 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14227 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14228 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14229 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14230 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14231 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14232 occurs.
14233
14234 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14235 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14236 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14237 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14238 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14239 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14240 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14241 cookies" below for more details.
14242
14243 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14244 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14245 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14246 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14247 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14248 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14249 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14250 and cookies" below for more details.
14251
14252 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14253 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14254 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14255 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14256 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14257 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14258 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14259 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14260
14261
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200142628.2.4. Custom log format
14263------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014264
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014265The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014266mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014267
14268HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14269Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14270separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14271prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14272
14273Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14274variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
14275string formats ("Q").
14276
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014277If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014278as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014279less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14280the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14281
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014282Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014283In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014284in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014285
14286Flags are :
14287 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014288 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014289
14290 Example:
14291
14292 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14293 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14294
14295At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14296
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014297 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14298 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014299
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014300the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014301
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014302 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014303 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014304 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014305
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014306and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14307
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014308 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014309 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14310
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014311Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14312
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014313 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014314 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014315 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14316 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14317 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014318 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14319 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14320 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014321 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014322 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14323 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014324 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014325 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14326 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014327 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014328 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014329 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014330 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014331 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014332 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14333 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014334 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014335 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14336 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014337 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014338 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14339 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014340 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14341 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14342 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014343 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014344 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14345 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014346 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014347 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14348 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14349 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014350 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014351 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014352 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14353 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14354 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14355 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014356 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014357 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014358 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014359 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014360 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014361 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014362 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14363 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14364 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014365 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014366 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14367 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014368 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014369 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014370 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014371 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014372
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014373 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014374
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014375
143768.2.5. Error log format
14377-----------------------
14378
14379When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14380protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14381By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14382"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14383will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14384logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14385
14386The format looks like this :
14387
14388 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14389 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14390 Connection error during SSL handshake
14391
14392 Field Format Extract from the example above
14393 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14394 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14395 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14396 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14397 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14398
14399These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14400failures.
14401
14402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144038.3. Advanced logging options
14404-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014405
14406Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14407just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14408options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14409for more information about their usage.
14410
14411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144128.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14413------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014414
14415It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14416haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14417commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14418monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14419ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14420
14421 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14422 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14423 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14424 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14425
14426 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14427 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14428 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014429 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014430 such as other load-balancers.
14431
14432 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14433 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14434 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14435
14436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144378.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14438----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014439
14440The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14441what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14442or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14443"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14444just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14445log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14446after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14447is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14448with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14449with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14450
14451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144528.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14453------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014454
14455Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14456for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14457"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14458retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14459raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14460a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14461file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14462you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14463"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14464
14465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144668.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14467--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014468
14469Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14470multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14471them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14472"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14473logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14474error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14475and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14476too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14477useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14478alternative.
14479
14480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144818.4. Timing events
14482------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014483
14484Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14485reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14486the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14487frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14488mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14489
14490 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14491 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14492 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14493 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14494 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14495
14496 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14497 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14498 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14499 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14500 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14501
14502 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14503 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14504 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14505 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14506 connection never established.
14507
14508 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14509 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14510 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14511 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14512 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14513 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14514 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14515 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14516 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14517 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14518 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14519
14520 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14521 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14522 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14523 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014524 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014525
14526 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14527
14528 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14529 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14530 negative.
14531
14532These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14533protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14534that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014535due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014536close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14537session has been aborted on timeout.
14538
14539Most common cases :
14540
14541 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14542 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14543 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14544 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14545 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14546 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14547 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14548 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14549 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014550 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14551 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14552 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014553
14554 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14555 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14556 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14557 of ms on remote networks.
14558
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014559 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14560 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14561 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014562
14563 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14564 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14565 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14566 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14567 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14568 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14569 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14570 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14571 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14572 to the server until another one is released.
14573
14574Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14575
14576 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14577 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14578 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14579
14580 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14581 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14582 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14583
14584 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14585 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14586 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14587 flags.
14588
14589 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14590 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14591 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14592 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14593 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14594 the client connection was maintained open.
14595
14596 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014597 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014598 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14599 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14600
14601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146028.5. Session state at disconnection
14603-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014604
14605TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14606"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
146072-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14608each of which has a special meaning :
14609
14610 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14611 session to terminate :
14612
14613 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14614
14615 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14616 server explicitly refused it.
14617
14618 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14619 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14620 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14621 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014622 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14623
14624 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14625 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014626
14627 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14628 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14629 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14630 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14631 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14632
14633 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14634 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14635 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14636 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14637 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14638
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014639 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14640 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14641
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014642 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14643 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14644 backup connections when going up.
14645
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014646 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014648 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14649 send or receive data.
14650
14651 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14652 send or receive data.
14653
14654 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14655 with nothing left in the buffers.
14656
14657 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14658
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014659 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014660 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14661
14662 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14663 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14664 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14665 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14666 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14667
14668 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14669 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14670
14671 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14672 server (HTTP only).
14673
14674 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14675
14676 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14677 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14678 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14679
14680 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14681 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14682 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14683
14684 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14685
14686 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14687 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14688
14689 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14690 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14691 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14692
14693 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14694 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014695 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14696 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014697
14698 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14699 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14700 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14701 another server.
14702
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014703 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014704 server.
14705
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014706 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14707 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14708 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14709 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14710
14711 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14712 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14713 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14714 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14715
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014716 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14717 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14718 "use-server" rule).
14719
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014720 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14721
14722 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14723 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14724
14725 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14726
14727 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14728 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14729 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14730
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014731 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14732 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014733 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014734 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14735 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14736
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014737 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14738
14739 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14740 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14741
14742 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14743
14744 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14745
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014746The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14747was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014748helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14749starvation, attacks, etc...
14750
14751The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14752alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14753easier finding and understanding.
14754
14755 Flags Reason
14756
14757 -- Normal termination.
14758
14759 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14760 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14761 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14762 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14763
14764 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14765 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14766 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14767 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14768 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14769 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014770
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014771 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14772 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014773 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014774
14775 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14776 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14777 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14778
14779 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14780 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14781 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14782 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14783 the server takes too long to respond.
14784
14785 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14786 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14787 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14788 long a time to respond.
14789
14790 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14791 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14792 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14793 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014794 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14795 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014796
14797 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14798 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14799 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14800 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14801 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014802 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014803 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14804 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14805 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14806 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14807 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14808 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14809 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14810 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14811 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14812 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14813 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14814 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014815
14816 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14817 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014818 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14819 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14820 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14821 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014822
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014823 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14824 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014826 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014827 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14828 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14829 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14830 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14831 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14832
14833 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14834 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14835 503 or 504 here.
14836
14837 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14838 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14839 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14840 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14841 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14842
14843 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14844 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014845 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014846 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14847 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14848
14849 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14850 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14851 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14852 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14853 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14854 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14855 between haproxy and the server.
14856
14857 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14858 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14859 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14860 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14861 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14862 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14863 solution is to fix the application.
14864
14865 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14866 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14867 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14868 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14869 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14870 external attacks.
14871
14872 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14873 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014874 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014875 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14876 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14877
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014878 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14879 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14880 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014881 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14882 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014883
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014884 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14885 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14886 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14887 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014888 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14889 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14890 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14891 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14892 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014893
14894 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14895 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14896 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14897 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14898
14899 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14900 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14901 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14902 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14903
14904 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14905 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14906 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14907 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14908
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014909The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14910persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14911important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14912re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14913
14914 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14915
14916 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14917 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14918 set on a GET request.
14919
14920 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14921 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014922 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014923 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14924
14925 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14926 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14927 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14928
14929 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14930 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14931 already got a cookie.
14932
14933 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14934 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14935 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14936 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14937 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14938
14939 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14940 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14941 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14942
14943 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14944 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14945 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14946
14947 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14948 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14949
14950 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14951 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14952 then advertised in the response.
14953
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149558.6. Non-printable characters
14956-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014957
14958In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14959consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14960converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14961prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14962being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14963escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14964is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14965'}' when logging headers.
14966
14967Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14968issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14969containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14970
14971Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14972the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14973performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14974
14975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149768.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14977---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014978
14979Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14980achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014981section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014982cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14983the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14984the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014985locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014986not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14987user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14988a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14989wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14990
14991 Examples :
14992 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14993 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14994
14995 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14996 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14997
14998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15000---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015001
15002Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15003proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15004the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15005server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15006
15007Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15008response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015009section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015010
15011It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015012time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15013appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015014are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15015and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15016follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15017request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15018in the logs.
15019
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015020As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15021frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15022an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015024 Example :
15025 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15026 listen proxy-out
15027 mode http
15028 option httplog
15029 option logasap
15030 log global
15031 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15032
15033 # log the name of the virtual server
15034 capture request header Host len 20
15035
15036 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15037 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15038
15039 # log the beginning of the referrer
15040 capture request header Referer len 20
15041
15042 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15043 capture response header Server len 20
15044
15045 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15046 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15047
15048 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15049 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15050
15051 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15052 capture response header Via len 20
15053
15054 # log the URL location during a redirection
15055 capture response header Location len 20
15056
15057 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15058 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15059 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15060 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15061 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15062
15063 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15064 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15065 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15066 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015067 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015068
15069 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15070 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15071 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15072 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15073 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015074 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015075
15076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150778.9. Examples of logs
15078---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015079
15080These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15081them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15082reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15083
15084 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15085 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15086 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15087
15088 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15089 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15090
15091 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15092 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15093 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15094
15095 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15096 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15097
15098 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15099 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15100 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15101
15102 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015103 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015104 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15105 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15106
15107 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15108 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15109 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15110
15111 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15112 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015113 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015114 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15115 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15116 to return the 502 and not the server.
15117
15118 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015119 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015120
15121 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15122 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15123 Nothing was sent to any server.
15124
15125 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15126 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15127
15128 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15129 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15130 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15131 send a 408 return code to the client.
15132
15133 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15134 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15135
15136 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15137 5 seconds ("c----").
15138
15139 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15140 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015141 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015142
15143 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015144 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015145 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15146 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15147 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15148 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15149 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015150
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151529. Statistics and monitoring
15153----------------------------
15154
15155It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
15156mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
15157CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
15158Unix socket.
15159
15160
151619.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015162---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010015163
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010015164The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020015165page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
15166begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
15167represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
15168use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
15169('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
15170(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
15171text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
15172do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
15173use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010015174
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015175In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
15176that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
15177S (Servers).
15178
15179 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
15180 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
15181 any name for server/listener)
15182 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
15183 number queued without a server assigned.
15184 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
15185 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
15186 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
15187 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
15188 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
15189 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
15190 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
15191 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
15192 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
15193 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
15194 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
15195 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
15196 "option checkcache".
15197 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
15198 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
15199 - read error from the client
15200 - client timeout
15201 - client closed connection
15202 - various bad requests from the client.
15203 - request was tarpitted.
15204 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
15205 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
15206 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
15207 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
15208 active servers).
15209 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
15210 Some other errors are:
15211 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
15212 - failure applying filters to the response.
15213 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
15214 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
15215 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
15216 switched away from.
15217 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020015218 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
15219 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
15220 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015221 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
15222 the server is up.)
15223 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
15224 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
15225 counters for each server.
15226 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
15227 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
15228 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
15229 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
15230 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
15231 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
15232 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
15233 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
15234 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
15235 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
15236 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
15237 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
15238 of times that server was selected.
15239 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
15240 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
15241 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
15242 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
15243 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
15244 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015245 UNK -> unknown
15246 INI -> initializing
15247 SOCKERR -> socket error
15248 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080015249 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015250 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
15251 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
15252 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
15253 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
15254 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
15255 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
15256 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
15257 disable-on-404
15258 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
15259 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
15260 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015261 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
15262 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
15263 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
15264 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
15265 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
15266 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
15267 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
15268 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
15269 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
15270 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
15271 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
15272 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
15273 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
15274 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
15275 (inc. in eresp)
15276 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
15277 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
15278 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
15279 (CPU/BW limit)
15280 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
15281 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
15282 server/backend
15283 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
15284 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
15285 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15286 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15287 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15288 (0 for TCP)
15289 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
15290 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015291
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152939.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015294-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015295
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015296The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
15297necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
15298A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
15299issuing commands by hand :
15300
15301 global
15302 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15303 stats timeout 2m
15304
15305It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
15306the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
15307never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
15308situations :
15309
15310 global
15311 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15312 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
15313 stats timeout 2m
15314
15315To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
15316swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
15317to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
15318syntaxes we'll use are the following :
15319
15320 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
15321 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
15322
15323The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
15324script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
15325for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
15326
15327The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
15328that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
15329editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
15330(eg: watch a counter).
15331
15332The socket supports two operation modes :
15333 - interactive
15334 - non-interactive
15335
15336The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
15337this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
15338sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
15339mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
15340commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
15341example :
15342
15343 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
15344
15345The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
15346entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
15347for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
15348sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
15349"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
15350after processing the last command of the same line.
15351
15352For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
15353"prompt" command :
15354
15355 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
15356 prompt
15357 > show info
15358 ...
15359 >
15360
15361Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
15362delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
15363that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
15364parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015365
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015366It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
15367on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
15368own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015369
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015370The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
15371If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
15372all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
15373it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
15374
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015375add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015376 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
15377 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
15378 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
15379 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015380
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015381add map <map> <key> <value>
15382 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
15383 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015384 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
15385 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
15386 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015388clear counters
15389 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
15390 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
15391 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
15392 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
15393 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15394
15395clear counters all
15396 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
15397 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
15398 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
15399
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015400clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015401 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
15402 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
15403 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015404
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015405clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015406 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
15407 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
15408 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015409
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015410clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
15411 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
15412
15413 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
15414 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
15415 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
15416 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
15417 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
15418 later after the session ends is usual enough.
15419
15420 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
15421
15422 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
15423 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
15424 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
15425 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
15426 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
15427 the ACLs :
15428
15429 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15430 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15431 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15432 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15433 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15434 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15435
15436 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015437 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
15438 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015439
15440 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015441 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015442 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015443 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15444 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15445 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15446 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015447
15448 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15449
15450 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015451 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015452 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15453 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015454 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15455 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15456 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015457
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015458del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15459 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015460 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15461 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15462 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15463 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015464
15465del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015466 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015467 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15468 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15469 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15470 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015471
15472disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015473 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15474
15475 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15476 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15477 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15478 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15479 re-enabled using enable agent.
15480
15481 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15482 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15483 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15484 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15485 otherwise unchanged.
15486
15487 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15488 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15489 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15490
15491 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15492 level "admin".
15493
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015494disable frontend <frontend>
15495 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15496 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15497 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15498 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15499 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15500 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15501 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15502 on the stats page.
15503
15504 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15505 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15506
15507 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15508 level "admin".
15509
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015510disable health <backend>/<server>
15511 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15512 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15513 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15514 agent check forces it down.
15515
15516 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15517 level "admin".
15518
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015519disable server <backend>/<server>
15520 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15521 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15522 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15523 during the maintenance.
15524
15525 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15526 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15527
15528 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015529 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015530
15531 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15532 level "admin".
15533
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015534enable agent <backend>/<server>
15535 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15536
15537 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15538 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15539
15540 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15541 level "admin".
15542
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015543enable frontend <frontend>
15544 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15545 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15546 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15547 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15548 which was disabled.
15549
15550 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15551 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15552
15553 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15554 level "admin".
15555
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015556enable health <backend>/<server>
15557 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15558 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15559
15560 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15561 level "admin".
15562
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015563enable server <backend>/<server>
15564 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15565 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15566
15567 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015568 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015569
15570 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15571 level "admin".
15572
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015573get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015574get acl <acl> <value>
15575 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15576 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15577 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15578 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15579 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015580
15581 The first two words are:
15582
15583 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15584 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15585 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15586
15587 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15588
15589 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15590
15591 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15592
15593 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15594 interpretation of the case.
15595
15596 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15597 useful with regular expressions.
15598
15599 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15600 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15601
15602 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15603 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15604 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15605
15606 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15607
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015608get weight <backend>/<server>
15609 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15610 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15611 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15612 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15613 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015614 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015615
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015616help
15617 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15618 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015619
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015620prompt
15621 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15622 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15623 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15624 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15625 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15626 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15627 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15628 command.
15629
15630quit
15631 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015632
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015633set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015634 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15635 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15636 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015637
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015638set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015639 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15640 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15641 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15642 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15643 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015644 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15645 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15646
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015647set maxconn global <maxconn>
15648 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15649 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15650 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15651 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15652 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15653 setting.
15654
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015655set rate-limit connections global <value>
15656 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15657 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15658 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15659 is passed in number of connections per second.
15660
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015661set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15662 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15663 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015664 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15665 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015666
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015667set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15668 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15669 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15670 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15671 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15672
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015673set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15674 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15675 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15676 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15677 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15678 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15679
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015680set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15681 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15682
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015683set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15684 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15685 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15686 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15687
15688set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15689 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15690 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15691 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15692
15693set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15694 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15695 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15696 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15697 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15698 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15699 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15700 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15701 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15702
15703set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15704 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15705 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15706
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015707set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15708 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15709 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15710 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15711 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15712
15713 Example:
15714 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15715 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15716 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15717 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15718
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015719set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15720 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15721 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15722 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15723 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15724 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15725
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015726set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015727 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15728 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15729 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15730 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015731 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15732 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015733
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015734set timeout cli <delay>
15735 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15736 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15737 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15738
15739set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15740 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15741 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015742 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15743 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15744 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15745 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15746 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15747 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15748 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15749 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15750 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15751 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15752 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15753 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15754 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015755
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015756show errors [<iid>]
15757 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15758 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015759 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15760 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15761 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015762
15763 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15764 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15765 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15766 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15767 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15768 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15769 are reported too.
15770
15771 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15772 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15773 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15774 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15775 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15776 code.
15777
15778 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15779 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15780 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15781 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15782 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15783 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15784 line.
15785
15786 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015787 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15788 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015789 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15790 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15791
15792 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15793 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15794 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15795 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15796 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15797 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15798 00204+ minal\r\n
15799 00211 \r\n
15800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015801 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015802 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15803 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15804 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15805 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15806 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15807 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015808
Baptiste Assmann9b6857e2015-09-18 14:49:12 +020015809show backend
15810 Dump the list of backends available in the running process
15811
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015812show info
15813 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15814
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015815show map [<map>]
15816 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015817 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15818 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15819 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15820 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15821 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15822 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015823
15824show acl [<acl>]
15825 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015826 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15827 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15828 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15829 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15830 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015831
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015832show pools
15833 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15834 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15835 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15836 the pools.
15837
Baptiste Assmann6f9225a2015-05-08 19:35:08 +020015838show servers state [<backend>]
15839 Dump the state of the servers found in the running configuration. A backend
15840 name or identifier may be provided to limit the output to this backend only.
15841
15842 The dump has the following format:
15843 - first line contains the format version (1 in this specification);
15844 - second line contains the column headers, prefixed by a sharp ('#');
15845 - third line and next ones contain data;
15846 - each line starting by a sharp ('#') is considered as a comment.
15847
15848 Since multiple versions of the ouptput may co-exist, below is the list of
15849 fields and their order per file format version :
15850 1:
15851 be_id: Backend unique id.
15852 be_name: Backend label.
15853 srv_id: Server unique id (in the backend).
15854 srv_name: Server label.
15855 srv_addr: Server IP address.
15856 srv_op_state: Server operational state (UP/DOWN/...).
15857 In source code: SRV_ST_*.
15858 srv_admin_state: Server administrative state (MAINT/DRAIN/...).
15859 In source code: SRV_ADMF_*.
15860 srv_uweight: User visible server's weight.
15861 srv_iweight: Server's initial weight.
15862 srv_time_since_last_change: Time since last operational change.
15863 srv_check_status: Last health check status.
15864 srv_check_result: Last check result (FAILED/PASSED/...).
15865 In source code: CHK_RES_*.
15866 srv_check_health: Checks rise / fall current counter.
15867 srv_check_state: State of the check (ENABLED/PAUSED/...).
15868 In source code: CHK_ST_*.
15869 srv_agent_state: State of the agent check (ENABLED/PAUSED/...).
15870 In source code: CHK_ST_*.
15871 bk_f_forced_id: Flag to know if the backend ID is forced by
15872 configuration.
15873 srv_f_forced_id: Flag to know if the server's ID is forced by
15874 configuration.
15875
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015876show sess
15877 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015878 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15879 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15880
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015881show sess <id>
15882 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15883 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15884 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15885 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15886 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015887 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15888 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15889
15890 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15891 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015892
15893show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15894 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15895 possible to dump only selected items :
15896 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15897 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15898 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15899 for example:
15900 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15901 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15902 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15903
15904 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015905 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15906 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015907 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15908 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15909 Nbproc: 1
15910 Process_num: 1
15911 (...)
15912
15913 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15914 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15915 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15916 (...)
15917 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15918
15919 $
15920
15921 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15922 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15923 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15924 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015925 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015926
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015927show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15928 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15929 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15930 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15931 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15932 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15933 cname: number of CNAME responses
15934 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15935 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15936 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15937 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15938 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15939 other: any other DNS errors
15940 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15941 too_big: too big response
15942 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15943
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015944show table
15945 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15946 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15947 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15948 entries currently in use.
15949
15950 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015951 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015952 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15953 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015954
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015955show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015956 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15957 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15958 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015959 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15960
15961 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15962 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15963 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15964 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15965 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15966
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015967 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15968 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15969 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15970 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15971 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15972 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15973
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015974
15975 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015976 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15977 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015978
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015979 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015980 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015981 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015982 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15983 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15984 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15985 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015986
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015987 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015988 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015989 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15990 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015991
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015992 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15993 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015994 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015995 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15996 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015997
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015998 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15999 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090016000 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090016001 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
16002 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
16003
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016004 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
16005 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
16006 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
16007 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
16008 time goes, the average event rate drops.
16009
16010 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
16011 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
16012 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016013 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
16014 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016015 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
16016 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020016017
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020016018show tls-keys
16019 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
16020 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
16021 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
16022
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020016023shutdown frontend <frontend>
16024 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
16025 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
16026 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
16027 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
16028 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
16029 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
16030 once it is terminated.
16031
16032 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
16033 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
16034
16035 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
16036 level "admin".
16037
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020016038shutdown session <id>
16039 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
16040 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
16041 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
16042 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
16043 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
16044 flag in the logs.
16045
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020016046shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016047 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
16048 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
16049 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
16050 'K' flag in the logs.
16051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016052/*
16053 * Local variables:
16054 * fill-column: 79
16055 * End:
16056 */